US20080318998A1 - Alkyloxy Substituted Thiazoloquinolines and Thiazolonaphthyridines - Google Patents

Alkyloxy Substituted Thiazoloquinolines and Thiazolonaphthyridines Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20080318998A1
US20080318998A1 US11/884,052 US88405206A US2008318998A1 US 20080318998 A1 US20080318998 A1 US 20080318998A1 US 88405206 A US88405206 A US 88405206A US 2008318998 A1 US2008318998 A1 US 2008318998A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
group
alkyl
het
alkylene
substituted
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US11/884,052
Inventor
Ryan B. Prince
Bryon A. Merrill
Philip D. Heppner
Tushar M. Kshirsagar
Joshua R. Wurst
Karl J. Manske
Michael J. Rice
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
3M Innovative Properties Co
Original Assignee
Coley Pharmaceutical Group inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Coley Pharmaceutical Group inc filed Critical Coley Pharmaceutical Group inc
Priority to US11/884,052 priority Critical patent/US20080318998A1/en
Assigned to 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY reassignment 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: HEPPNER, PHILIP D., KSHIRSAGAR, TUSHAR A., MERRILL, BYRON A., PRINCE, RYAN B.
Assigned to 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY reassignment 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: MERRILL, BYRON A., WURST, JOSHUA R., HEPPNER, PHILIP D., KSHIRSAGAR, TUSHAR A., MANSKE, KARL J., PRINCE, RYAN B.
Assigned to COLEY PHARMACEUTICAL GROUP, INC. reassignment COLEY PHARMACEUTICAL GROUP, INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: 3M COMPANY & 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY
Assigned to 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY reassignment 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: RICE, MICHAEL J.
Publication of US20080318998A1 publication Critical patent/US20080318998A1/en
Assigned to 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY reassignment 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: COLEY PHARMACEUTICAL GROUP, INC.
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D513/00Heterocyclic compounds containing in the condensed system at least one hetero ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for in groups C07D463/00, C07D477/00 or C07D499/00 - C07D507/00
    • C07D513/02Heterocyclic compounds containing in the condensed system at least one hetero ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for in groups C07D463/00, C07D477/00 or C07D499/00 - C07D507/00 in which the condensed system contains two hetero rings
    • C07D513/04Ortho-condensed systems
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D519/00Heterocyclic compounds containing more than one system of two or more relevant hetero rings condensed among themselves or condensed with a common carbocyclic ring system not provided for in groups C07D453/00 or C07D455/00

Definitions

  • IRMs immune response modifiers
  • the present invention provides a new class of compounds that are useful in inducing cytokine biosynthesis in animals.
  • Such compounds are of the following Formula I:
  • R A , R B , and R′′ are as defined below.
  • the compounds of Formula I are useful as immune response modifiers due to their ability to induce cytokine biosynthesis (e.g., induces the synthesis of at least one cytokine) and otherwise modulate the immune response when administered to animals. This makes the compounds useful in the treatment of a variety of conditions such as viral diseases and tumors that are responsive to such changes in the immune response.
  • the invention further provides pharmaceutical compositions containing an effective amount of a compound of Formula I and methods of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal, treating a viral infection or disease and/or treating a neoplastic disease in an animal by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I to the animal.
  • the present invention provides compounds of the following Formulas I through VII:
  • R A , R B , R′′, R, R 2 , R 3 , n, G, and Z are as defined below.
  • the present invention provides a compound of Formula I:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • R′′ is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)O 0-2 —, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • the present invention provides a compound of Formula II:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • n 0 or 1
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • the present invention provides a compound selected from the group consisting Formulas III, IV, V, and VI:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • n 0 or 1
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • the present invention provides a compound (which is a prodrug) of Formula VII:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • G is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R′ and R′′′ are independently selected from the group consisting of C 1-10 alkyl, C 3-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, and benzyl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, nitro, cyano, carboxy, C 1-6 alkyl, C 1-4 alkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, aryl-C 1-4 alkylenyl, heteroaryl-C 1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C 1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C 1-4 alkoxy, —O—C(O)—CH 3 , —C(O)—O—CH 3 , —C(O)—NH 2 , —O—CH 2 —C(O)—NH 2 , —NH 2 , and —S(O) 2 —NH 2 , with the proviso that R′′′ can also be hydrogen;
  • ⁇ -aminoacyl is an ⁇ -aminoacyl group derived from an amino acid selected from the group consisting of racemic, D-, and L-amino acids;
  • Y 1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-6 alkyl, and benzyl;
  • Y 0 is selected from the group consisting of C 1-6 alkyl, carboxy-C 1-6 alkylenyl, amino-C 1-4 alkylenyl, mono-N—C 1-6 alkylamino-C 1-4 alkylenyl, and di-N,N—C 1-6 alkylamino-C 1-4 alkylenyl;
  • Y 2 is selected from the group consisting of mono-N—C 1-6 alkylamino, di-N,N—C 1-6 alkylamino, morpholin-4-yl, piperidin-1-yl, pyrrolidin-1-yl, and 4-C 1-4 alkylpiperazin-1-yl;
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)O 0-2 —, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula X, which is also an IRM:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • n 0 or 1
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula XI, which is also an IRM:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • n 0 or 1
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula XII:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • n 0 or 1
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen,
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula XIII:
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl
  • n 0or 1
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alklylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —-, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 9 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —;
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7;
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • non-interfering means that the ability of the compound or salt, which includes a non-interfering substituent, to modulate the biosynthesis of one or more cytokines is not destroyed by the non-interfering substituent.
  • Illustrative non-interfering R′′ groups include those described above for R 2 .
  • alkyl As used herein, the terms “alkyl”, “alkenyl”, “alkynyl” and the prefix “alk-” are inclusive of both straight chain and branched chain groups and of cyclic groups, e.g., cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl. Unless otherwise specified, these groups contain from 1 to carbon atoms, with alkenyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms, and alkynyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms. In some embodiments, these groups have a total of up to 10 carbon atoms, up to 8 carbon atoms, up to 6 carbon atoms, or up to 4 carbon atoms.
  • Cyclic groups can be monocyclic or polycyclic and preferably have from 3 to 10 ring carbon atoms.
  • Exemplary cyclic groups include cyclopropyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexyl, cyclohexylmethyl, adamantyl, and substituted and unsubstituted bornyl, norbornyl, and norbornenyl.
  • alkylene “-alkylene-”, “alkenylene”, “-alkenylene-”, “alkynylene”, and “-alkynylene-” are the divalent forms of the “alkyl”, “alkenyl”, and “alkynyl” groups defined above.
  • the terms “alkylenyl”, “alkenylenyl”, and “alkynylenyl” are used when “alkylene”, “alkenylene”, and “alkynylene”, respectively, are substituted.
  • an arylalkylenyl group comprises an “alkylene” moiety to which an aryl group is attached.
  • haloalkyl is inclusive of alkyl groups that are substituted by one or more halogen atoms, including perfluorinated groups. This is also true of other groups that include the prefix “halo-”. Examples of suitable haloalkyl groups are chloromethyl, trifluoromethyl, and the like.
  • aryl as used herein includes carbocyclic aromatic rings or ring systems. Examples of aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, biphenyl, fluorenyl and indenyl.
  • heteroatom refers to the atoms O, S, or N.
  • heteroaryl includes aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N).
  • heteroaryl includes a ring or ring system that contains 2 to 12 carbon atoms, 1 to 3 rings, 1 to 4 heteroatoms, and O, S, and/or N as the heteroatoms.
  • Suitable heteroaryl groups include furyl, thienyl, pyridyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, triazolyl, pyrrolyl, tetrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzothiophenyl, carbazolyl, benzoxazolyl, pyrimidinyl, benzimidazolyl, quinoxalinyl, benzothiazolyl, naphthyridinyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, purinyl, quinazolinyl, pyrazinyl, 1-oxidopyridyl, pyridazinyl, triazinyl, tetrazinyl, oxadiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, and so on.
  • heterocyclyl includes non-aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N) and includes all of the fully saturated and partially unsaturated derivatives of the above mentioned heteroaryl groups.
  • heterocyclyl includes a ring or ring system that contains 2 to 12 carbon atoms, 1 to 3 rings, 1 to 4 heteroatoms, and O, S, and N as the heteroatoms.
  • heterocyclyl groups include pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, thiazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, isothiazolidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, quinuclidinyl, homopiperidinyl (azepanyl), 1,4-oxazepanyl, homopiperazinyl (diazepanyl), 1,3-dioxolanyl, aziridinyl, azetidinyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imi
  • heterocyclyl includes bicylic and tricyclic heterocyclic ring systems. Such ring systems include fused and/or bridged rings and spiro rings. Fused rings can include, in addition to a saturated or partially saturated ring, an aromatic ring, for example, a benzene ring. Spiro rings include two rings joined by one spiro atom and three rings joined by two spiro atoms.
  • heterocyclyl contains a nitrogen atom
  • the point of attachment of the heterocyclyl group may be the nitrogen atom
  • arylene is the divalent forms of the “aryl”, “heteroaryl”, and “heterocyclyl” groups defined above.
  • arylenyl is used when “arylene”, “heteroarylene,” and “heterocyclylene”, respectively, are substituted.
  • an alkylarylenyl group comprises an arylene moiety to which an alkyl group is attached.
  • each group is independently selected, whether explicitly stated or not.
  • each R 8 group is independently selected for the formula —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )— each R 8 group is independently selected.
  • each R 4 group is independently selected when an R 2 and an R 3 group both contain an R 4 group.
  • each Y group is independently selected, and each R 8 group is independently selected.
  • the invention is inclusive of the compounds described herein (including intermediates) in any of their pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers (e.g., diastereomers and enantiomers), salts, solvates, polymorphs, prodrugs, and the like.
  • isomers e.g., diastereomers and enantiomers
  • salts e.g., sodium bicarbonate
  • solvates e.g., sodium bicarbonate
  • polymorphs e.g., sodium bicarbonate
  • prodrugs e.g., sodium bicarbonate
  • the term “compound” includes any or all of such forms, whether explicitly stated or not (although at times, “salts” are explicitly stated).
  • prodrug means a compound that can be transformed in vivo to yield an immune response modifying compound, including any of the salt, solvated, polymorphic, or isomeric forms described above.
  • the prodrug itself, may be an immune response modifying compound, including any of the salt, solvated, polymorphic, or isomeric forms described above.
  • the transformation may occur by various mechanisms, such as through a chemical (e.g., solvolysis or hydrolysis, for example, in the blood) or enzymatic biotransformation.
  • a discussion of the use of prodrugs is provided by T. Higuchi and W. Stella, “Pro-drugs as Novel Delivery Systems,” Vol. 14 of the A. C. S. Symposium Series, and in Bioreversible Carriers in Drug Design, ed. Edward B. Roche, American Pharmaceutical Association and Pergamon Press, 1987.
  • each one of the following variables e.g., Z, X, Y, Y′, R A , R B , R, R 2 , R 3 , Q, n, and so on
  • each one of the following variables e.g., Z, X, Y, Y′, R A , R B , R, R 2 , R 3 , Q, n, and so on
  • each one of the following variables in any of its embodiments can be combined with any one or more of the other variables in any of their embodiments and associated with any one of the formulas described herein, as would be understood by one of skill in the art.
  • Each of the resulting combinations of variables is an embodiment of the present invention.
  • R A and R B are taken together to form a fused benzene ring wherein the benzene ring is substituted by one —O—R 3 group, or substituted by one —O—R 3 group and one R group. In certain of these embodiments, the fused benzene ring is substituted by one —O—R 3 group.
  • R A and R B are taken together to form a fused pyridine ring wherein the pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R 3 group, or substituted by one —O—R 3 group and one R group. In certain of these embodiments, the fused pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R 3 group.
  • the compound selected from the group consisting of Formulas III, IV, V, and VI, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof is the compound of Formula III:
  • n is 0 in the above embodiments of Formulas II, III, IV, V, and VI.
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl.
  • R′′ is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent.
  • R′′ is a non-interfering substituent
  • R′′ is R 2 ; wherein R 2 is selected from the group consisting of —R 4 , —X—R 4 , —X—Y′—R 4 , and —X—R 5 ′.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of —R 4 , —X—R 4 , —X—Y′—R 4 , and —X—R 5 ′.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, and hydroxyalkylenyl.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, and alkoxyalkylenyl.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl and alkoxyalkylenyl.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, ethoxymethyl, methoxymethyl, 2-methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, and 2-hydroxyethyl.
  • R 2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, ethoxymethyl, methoxymethyl, and 2-methoxyethyl.
  • n is 0 and R 2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, and hydroxyalkylenyl.
  • R 3 is selected from the group consisting of -Z-Y—R 4 , -Z-Y—X—Y—R 4 , -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R 4 , -Z-R 5 , -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R 4 , and -Z-Het′-Y—R 4 .
  • R 3 is Z-Y—R 4 or -Z-Y—X—Y—R 4 .
  • Y is —N(R 8 )-Q-,
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O or ⁇ S
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, and C 1-4 alkoxyC 1-4 alkylenyl
  • R 10 is C 3-6 alkylene
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alk
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O) 2 —, and —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—;
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O or ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, and C 1-4 alkoxyC 1-4 alkylenyl;
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, and aryl; wherein aryl and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or
  • Y is —N(R 8 )-Q-.
  • Q is —C(O)—.
  • Q is —S(O) 2 —.
  • Q is —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—.
  • 4 is C 1-4 alkyl and R 9 is hydrogen.
  • R 4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by methoxy and R 8 is hydrogen.
  • Q is a bond.
  • R 4 is heterocyclyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl groups, and R 8 is C 1-4 alkyl.
  • R 4 is 1-methylpiperidin-4-yl and R 8 is methyl.
  • R 3 is -Z-Y—R 4 , wherein Y is —O— and R 4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, alkoxy, nitro, and haloalkyl.
  • R 3 is -Z-Y—X—Y, —R 4 , wherein Y is —O—, X is phenylene, and Y c —R 4 is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—O-alkyl, —S-alkyl, —NH—C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—NH 2 , and —S(O) 2 —NH 2 .
  • R 3 is -Z-R 5 .
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • A is —O—, —CH 2 —, or —S(O) 2 —;
  • R 7 is C 2-4 alkylene;
  • R 8 is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; and
  • a and b are each independently 1, 2, or 3.
  • R 5 is
  • R 7 is C 2-4 alkylene.
  • R 3 is -Z-Het or -Z-Het′-R 4 .
  • Het and Het′ are, respectively, selected from the group consisting of the monovalent and divalent forms of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, 1,4-oxazepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(
  • Het and Het′ are, respectively, selected from the group consisting of the monovalent and divalent forms of pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and morpholinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents.
  • Het is unsubstituted.
  • Het′ is unsubstituted.
  • Het is substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, and dialkylamino.
  • R 4 is heterocyclyl.
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of pyrrolidinyl and piperidinyl.
  • R 3 is -Z-Het′-Y—R 4 .
  • Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent form of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2B)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, and piperazinyl.
  • —Y—R 4 is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—O—H, —C(O)—O-alkyl, —C(O)—NH 2 —, —C(O)—NH-alkyl, and —NH—C(O)-alkyl.
  • R 3 includes a substituted or unsubstituted thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl group or a substituted or unsubstituted thiazolo[4,5-c]naphthyridinyl group and a connecting group such that the compound is a dimer.
  • R 3 is -Z—Y a —X—Y b —R 4 wherein Y a is —N(R 8 )-Q-, Y b is —O—, and R 4 is thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl or thiazolo[4,5-c]naphthyridinyl.
  • Q is —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—.
  • the thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl or thiazolo[4,5-c]naphthyridinyl group is substituted by alkyl and amino.
  • Z is alkylene optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups.
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of C 1-6 alkylene and —CH 2 CH 2 —O—CH 2 CH 2 —.
  • Z is a bond.
  • —O—R 3 is at the 7-position.
  • —O—R 3 is at the 8-position.
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy,
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl.
  • alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, and aryl.
  • alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, halogen, and aryl.
  • aryl and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy.
  • aryl, heteroaryl, and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy.
  • heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents.
  • R 4 is hydrogen or alkyl.
  • R 4 is alkyl
  • R 4 is C 1-4 alkyl.
  • R 4 is heterocyclyl.
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of pyrrolidinyl and piperidinyl.
  • R 4 is heterocyclyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl groups.
  • R 4 is 1-methylpiperidin-4-yl.
  • R 4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by methoxy.
  • R 4 is heteroaryl
  • R 4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, alkoxy, nitro, and haloalkyl.
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • A is —O—, —CH 2 —, or —S(O) 2 —;
  • R 7 is C 2-4 alkylene;
  • R 8 is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl; and
  • a and b are each independently 1, 2, or 3. In certain of these embodiments a and b are each 2.
  • R 5 is
  • R 7 is C 2-4 alkylene.
  • R 5 is
  • R 7 is C 2-4 alkylene.
  • R 5 ′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O and ⁇ S.
  • R 6 is ⁇ O.
  • R 6 is ⁇ S.
  • R 7 is C 2-7 alkylene.
  • R 7 is C 2-4 alkylene.
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene.
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene.
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene.
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl.
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, and C 1-4 alkoxyC 1-4 alkylenyl.
  • R 8 is hydrogen or C 1-4 alkyl.
  • R 8 is hydrogen
  • R 8 is C 1-4 alkyl.
  • R 8 is methyl.
  • R 9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl.
  • R 10 is C 3-8 alkylene.
  • R 10 is C 4-6 alkylene.
  • R 10 is C 3-6 alkylene.
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH 2 —, —C(O)—, —S(O) 0-2 —, and —N(R 4 )—.
  • A is —O—, —CH 2 —, or —S(O) 2 —.
  • A is —O— or —S(O) 2 —.
  • A is —O—.
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —, —N(-Q-R 4 )—, and —CH 2 —.
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —CH 2 —, —S(O) 2 —, and —O—.
  • A′ is —CH 2 —.
  • A′ is —O—.
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, and —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—.
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, and —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—.
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O) 2 —, and —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—.
  • Q is —C(O)—.
  • Q is —S(O) 2 —.
  • Q is —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—.
  • Q is a bond
  • V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R 6 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —.
  • V is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)— and —N(R 8 )—C(O)—.
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O) 2 —.
  • W is a bond or —C(O)—.
  • W is a bond
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups.
  • X is phenylene.
  • X is alkylene.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —O—C(O)—O—, —N(R 8 )-Q-, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—N(OR 8 )—, —O—N(R 8 )-Q-, —O—N ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C( ⁇ N—O—R 8 )—,
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of —S(O) 0-2 —, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —O—C(O)—O—, —N(R 8 )-Q-, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, —O—C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—N(OR 9 )—, —O—N(R 8 )-Q-, —O—N ⁇ C(R 4 )—, —C( ⁇ N—O—R 8 )—, —CH(—N(—O—R 8 )-Q-R 4 )—,
  • Y can also be —O—.
  • Y can also be —O— when Y is bonded to R 4 , and R 4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents.
  • the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy.
  • Y can also be —O— when Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene.
  • Y is —N(R 8 )-Q-
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, and —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—;
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O or ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, and C 1-4 alkoxyC 1-4 alkylenyl;
  • R 10 is C 3-6 alkylene; and
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of
  • Y is —N(R 8 )-Q- or
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O) 2 —, and —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—;
  • R 6 is selected from the group consisting of ⁇ O or ⁇ S;
  • R 7 is C 2-3 alkylene;
  • R 8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C 1-4 alkyl, and C 1-4 alkoxyC 1-4 alkylenyl;
  • R 4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, and aryl; wherein aryl and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or
  • Y is —N(R 8 )-Q-.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —C(O)—NH—, and —NH—C(O)—.
  • Y is —O—.
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S—, —NH—C(O)—, —C(O)—NH—, and —S(O) 2 —NH—.
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O) 0-2 —, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, —O—C(R 6 )—, —O—C(O)—O—, —N(R 9 )-Q-, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—,
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups.
  • Z is alkylene optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups.
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of C 1-6 alkylene and —CH 2 CH 2 —O—CH 2 CH 2 —. In certain of these embodiments, Z is selected from the group consisting of C 2-6 alkylene and —CH 2 CH 2 —O—CH 2 CH 2 —.
  • Z is a bond.
  • Z can be a bond when: R 3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R 4 , or -Z-Het′-Y—R 4 , and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or R 3 is -Z-Y—R 4 , -Z-Y—X—Y—R 4 , or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R 4 , and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O) 2 —, —S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—, —C(R 6 )—, —C(R 6 )—O—, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—,
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • R 3 is -Z-R 5
  • R 5 is
  • V is —C(R 6 )— or —S(O) 2 —, or
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het is selected from the group consisting of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, 1,4-oxazepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, 3-azabicyclo[3.2.2]non-3-yl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or
  • the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het is selected from the group consisting of pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and morpholinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents.
  • the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het is substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, hydroxyl, hydroxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, and dialkylamino.
  • Het is unsubstituted.
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent forms of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, 1,4-oxazepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, 3-azabicyclo[3.2.2]non-3-yl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted
  • the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent forms of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents.
  • the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent forms of pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and morpholinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents.
  • the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • Het′ is unsubstituted (except by —R 4 or —Y—R 4 ).
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ⁇ 7.
  • a and b are each independently 1, 2, or 3.
  • a and b are each 2.
  • n is 0 or 1.
  • n 0.
  • the —NH 2 group can be replaced by an —NH-G group, as shown in the compound of Formula VII, to form prodrugs.
  • G is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)—R′, ⁇ -aminoacyl, ⁇ -aminoacyl- ⁇ -aminoacyl, —C(O)—O—R′, —C(O)—N(R′′′)R′, —C( ⁇ NY 1 )—R′, —CH(OH)—C(O)—OY 1 , —CH(OC 1-4 alkyl)Y 0 , —CH 2 Y 2 , and —CH(CH 3 )Y 2 .
  • R′ and R′′′ are independently selected from the group consisting of C 1-10 alkyl, C 3-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, and benzyl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, nitro, cyano, carboxy, C 1-6 alkyl, C 1-4 alkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, aryl-C 1-4 alkylenyl, heteroaryl-C 1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C 1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C 1-4 alkoxy, —O—C(O)—CH 3 , —C(O)—O—CH 3 , —C(O)—NH 2 , —O—CH 2 —C(O)—NH 2 , —NH 2 , and —S(O) 2 —NH 2 with the proviso that R′′′ can also be hydrogen;
  • the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition
  • a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • the present invention provides a method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI to the animal.
  • the present invention provides a method of treating a viral disease in an animal comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI to the animal.
  • the present invention provides a method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI to the animal.
  • Compounds of the invention may be synthesized by synthetic routes that include processes analogous to those well known in the chemical arts, particularly in light of the description contained herein.
  • the starting materials are generally available from commercial sources such as Aldrich Chemicals (Milwaukee, Wis., USA) or are readily prepared using methods well known to those skilled in the art (e.g. prepared by methods generally described in Louis F. Fieser and Mary Fieser, Reagents for Organic Synthesis , v. 1-19, Wiley, New York, (1967-1999 ed.); Alan R. Katritsky, Otto Meth-Cohn, Charles W. Rees, Comprehensive Organic Functional Group Transformations , v 1-6, Pergamon Press, Oxford, England, (1995); Barry M.
  • reaction schemes depicted below provide potential routes for synthesizing the compounds of the present invention as well as key intermediates.
  • EXAMPLES section below For more detailed description of the individual reaction steps, see the EXAMPLES section below.
  • Other synthetic routes may be used to synthesize the compounds of the invention.
  • specific starting materials and reagents are depicted in the reaction schemes and discussed below, other starting materials and reagents can be easily substituted to provide a variety of derivatives and/or reaction conditions.
  • many of the compounds prepared by the methods described below can be further modified in light of this disclosure using conventional methods well known to those skilled in the art.
  • Suitable amino protecting groups include acetyl, trifluoroacetyl, tert-butoxycarbonyl (Boc), benzyloxycarbonyl, and 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl (Fmoc).
  • Suitable hydroxy protecting groups include acetyl and silyl groups such as the tert-butyl dimethylsilyl group.
  • Step (1) of Reaction Scheme I a benzyloxyaniline of Formula XV is treated with the condensation product generated from 2,2-dimethyl-1,3-dioxane-4,6-dione (Meldrum's acid) and triethyl orthoformate to provide an imine of Formula XVI.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding a solution of a benzyloxyaniline of Formula XV to a heated mixture of Meldrum's acid and triethyl orthoformate and heating the reaction at an elevated temperature such as 45° C.
  • step (2) of Reaction Scheme I an imine of Formula XVI undergoes thermolysis and cyclization to provide a benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVII.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out in a medium such as DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid at a temperature in the range of 200° C. to 250° C.
  • step (3) of Reaction Scheme I the benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVII is nitrated under conventional nitration conditions to provide a benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVIII.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding nitric acid to the benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVII in a suitable solvent such as propionic acid and heating the mixture at an elevated temperature such as 125° C.
  • a benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVIII is reduced to provide a 3-amino-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XIX or a salt thereof, such as the hydrochloride salt thereof.
  • the reaction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as platinum on carbon.
  • the hydrogenation is conveniently carried out in a Parr apparatus in a suitable solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF).
  • the reaction can be carried out at room temperature.
  • a 3-amino benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XIX is reacted with a carboxylic acid or an equivalent thereof to provide a compound of Formula XX.
  • Suitable equivalents to carboxylic acid include acid anhydrides and acid chlorides.
  • the selection of the carboxylic acid equivalent is determined by the desired substituent at R 2 .
  • the use of butyryl chloride provides a compound in which R 2 is a propyl group; the use of ethoxyacetyl chloride provides a compound in which R 2 is an ethoxymethyl group.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the acid chloride to a solution of a 3-aminobenzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XIX in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or acetonitrile in the presence of a tertiary amine such as triethylamine, pyridine, or 4-dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP) to afford an amide.
  • a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or acetonitrile
  • a tertiary amine such as triethylamine, pyridine, or 4-dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP)
  • DMAP 4-dimethylaminopyridine
  • the reaction can be carried out at or below room temperature.
  • the amide of Formula XX can optionally be isolated and purified.
  • step (6) of Reaction Scheme I an amide of Formula XX is reacted with phosphorus pentasulfide to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXI.
  • the reaction can be carried out by adding phosphorus pentasulfide to a solution or suspension of a compound of Formula XX in a suitable solvent such as pyridine and heating the resulting mixture at an elevated temperature, for example, the reflux temperature of the solvent.
  • a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXI is oxidized to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXII using a conventional oxidizing agent capable of forming N-oxides.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid to a solution of a compound of Formula XXI in a solvent such dichloromethane or chloroform. The reaction can be carried out at room temperature.
  • step (8) of Reaction Scheme I a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXII is aminated to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXIII.
  • Step (8) can be carried out by the activation of an N-oxide of Formula XXII by conversion to an ester and then reacting the ester with an aminating agent.
  • Suitable activating agents include alkyl- or arylsulfonyl chlorides such as benzenesulfonyl chloride, methanesulfonyl chloride, or p-toluenesulfonyl chloride.
  • Suitable aminating agents include ammonia, in the form of ammonium hydroxide, for example, and ammonium salts such as ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, and ammonium phosphate.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding ammonium hydroxide followed by p-toluenesulfonyl chloride to a solution of the N-oxide of Formula XXII in a suitable solvent such as 1,2-dichloroethane at elevated temperature, for example 65° C.
  • the reaction may also be carried out by adding ammonium hydroxide and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride to the reaction mixture from step (7) without isolating the N-oxide of Formula XXII.
  • step (8) can be carried out by the reaction of a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXII with trichloroacetyl isocyanate followed by hydrolysis of the resulting intermediate to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXIII.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out in two steps by (i) adding trichloroacetyl isocyanate to a solution of the N-oxide of Formula XXII in a solvent such as dichloromethane and stirring at room temperature to provide an isolable amide intermediate.
  • step (ii) a solution of the intermediate in methanol is treated with a base such as sodium methoxide or ammonium hydroxide at room temperature.
  • step (9) of Reaction Scheme I the benzyl group of a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXIII is cleaved to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV.
  • the cleavage is conveniently carried out with an acid such as hydrogen bromide in a suitable solvent such as acetic acid at an elevated temperature, such as 65° C.
  • the cleavage may be carried out on a Parr apparatus under hydrogenolysis conditions using a suitable heterogeneous catalyst such as palladium on carbon in a solvent such as ethanol.
  • step (10) of Reaction Scheme I a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV is converted to an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula II using a Williamson-type ether synthesis.
  • the reaction is effected by treating a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV with an alkyl halide of Formula Halide-R 3 in the presence of a base.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by combining the alkyl halide with a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV in a solvent such as DMF in the presence of a suitable base such as cesium carbonate.
  • the reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature, for example 60° C. to 85° C.
  • the reaction can be carried out by treating a solution of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV in a solvent such as DMF with sodium hydride and then adding a reagent of Formula Halide-R 3 .
  • reagents of Formulas Halide-Z-Y—R 4 and Halide-Z-Het wherein Z, Y, R 4 , and Het are as defined above, are commercially available. These include, for example, bromo-substituted ketones such as 2-bromoacetophenone and 2-bromo-1-(3-thienyl)-1-ethanone, bromo-substituted esters such as ethyl bromoacetate, and bromoalkyl-substituted heterocycles such as 2-(bromomethyl)tetrahydro-2H-pyran.
  • ketones such as 2-bromoacetophenone and 2-bromo-1-(3-thienyl)-1-ethanone
  • bromo-substituted esters such as ethyl bromoacetate
  • bromoalkyl-substituted heterocycles such as 2-(bromomethyl)tetrahydro-2H-pyran.
  • reagents of Formulas Halide-Z-Y—R 4 , Halide-Z-R 5 , Halide-Z-Y—X—Y—R 4 , and Halide-Z-Het wherein Z, Y, X, R 4 , R 5 , and Het are as defined above, can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods; for example, a bromo-substituted acid halide of Formula ClC(O)-Z-Br or BrC(O)-Z-Br can be treated with a secondary amine in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane to provide a variety of bromo-substituted amides of Formula Br-Z-C(O)—N(R 8 )—R 4 ,
  • reaction can be run at a sub-ambient temperature such as ⁇ 25° C.
  • Dimers of Formula II wherein R 3 is -Z-O—R 4 , wherein Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups, and R 4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R 4 above, can be prepared in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I if half an equivalent of a dialkyl halide of Formula Halide-Z-Halide is used, and the reaction can be carried out according to the conditions described above.
  • Step (10) of Reaction Scheme I can alternatively be carried out by treating a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV with an alcohol of Formula HO—R 3 under Mitsunobu reaction conditions.
  • Numerous alcohols of Formulas HO-Z-Y—R 4 , HO-Z-R 5 , and HO-Z-Het are commercially available, such as, for example, 1-(2-hydroxyethyl)pyrrolidin-2-one, 1-(3-hydroxypropyl)pyrrolidin-2-one, 3-(methylthio)propan-1-ol, and 3-hydroxytetrahydrofuran; other alcohols of Formula HO—R 3 can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by out by adding triphenylphosphine and an alcohol of Formula HO—R 3 to a solution of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV in a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran and then slowly adding diisopropyl azodicarboxylate or diethyl azodicarboxylate.
  • a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran
  • Step (1) of Reaction Scheme II the benzyl group of a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXI is cleaved to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV.
  • the reaction can be carried out as described in step (9) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • step (2) of Reaction Scheme II a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV is converted to an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XII.
  • the reaction can be carried out using one of the methods described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • steps (3) and (4) of Reaction Scheme II an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XII is oxidized to afford a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXVI, which is aminated to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula II.
  • Steps (3) and (4) can be carried out as described in steps (7) and (8), respectively, of Reaction Scheme I.
  • Synthetic transformations can be made at R 2 in compounds of Formulas XXI, XXIII, XXIV, XXV, XII, or II, shown in Reaction Scheme I or II, if, for example, the carboxylic acid or equivalent thereof used in step (5) of Reaction Scheme I contains a protected hydroxy or amino group.
  • Some acid chlorides of this type for example acetoxyacetyl chloride, are commercially available. Others can be prepared by known synthetic methods. A protected hydroxy or amino group thus installed at R 2 can then be deprotected by a variety of methods well-known to one of skill in the art.
  • an acetate group installed by using acetoxyacetyl chloride as the carboxylic acid equivalent in step (5) of Reaction Scheme I, is readily hydrolyzed under basic conditions to provide a hydroxy group.
  • the resulting hydroxy group can then be oxidized to an aldehyde or carboxylic acid or converted to a leaving group such as, for example, a chloro group using thionyl chloride or a trifluoromethanesulfonate group using trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride.
  • the resulting leaving group can then be displaced by a variety of nucleophiles.
  • Sodium azide can be used as the nucleophile to install an azide group, which can then be reduced to an amino group using heterogeneous hydrogenation conditions.
  • the amino group can then be converted to an amide, sulfonamide, sulfamide, or urea using one of the many methods described below in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV.
  • a leaving group at R 2 such as a chloro or trifluoromethanesulfonate group, can also be displaced with a secondary amine, a substituted phenol, or a mercaptan under the conditions described below in step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI to provide a variety of compounds.
  • R 2 groups see U.S. Pat. No. 6,110,929 (Gerster et al.).
  • a hydroxyalkylenyl group can also be introduced at R 2 by the demethylation of a methoxyalkylenyl group, which can be installed by using a methoxy-substituted carboxylic acid equivalent, for example, methoxyacetyl chloride and 2-methoxypropionyl chloride, in step (5) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • the demethylation can be carried out by treating a compound of Formula II wherein R 2 is a methoxyalkylenyl group with boron tribromide in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane at a sub-ambient temperature such as 0° C.
  • an R 3 group in a compound of Formula XII may contain a —S— functional group, which can be oxidized to —S(O) 2 — in step (3) of Reaction Scheme II using an excess of the oxidizing agent.
  • Step (4) of Reaction Scheme II may then be carried out to provide a compound of Formula II, wherein R 3 contains a —S(O) 2 — functional group.
  • an R 3 group in a compound of Formula II may be -Z-Y—R 4 , wherein Y is —C(O)—.
  • a ketone of this formula can then be converted to an oxime by adding an aqueous solution of a hydroxylamine salt of formula NH 2 OR 8 .HCl to a solution of the ketone in a suitable solvent such as methanol or ethanol and then adding a base such as sodium hydroxide and heating at an elevated temperature to provide a compound of the invention, wherein R 3 is -Z-Y—R 4 where Y is —C( ⁇ N—OR 8 )—, and R 4 and R 8 are as defined above.
  • the oxime so prepared may be reduced with sodium cyanoborohydride in a mixture of ethanol or methanol in acetic acid to provide a hydroxylamine, which may be treated with one of numerous acid chlorides, sulfonyl chloride, isocyanates, carbamoyl chloride, or sulfamoyl chlorides using one of the methods described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV below to provide a compound of the invention wherein R 3 is -Z-Y—R 4 where Y is —CH(—N—(OR 8 )-Q-R 4 )—, and Q, R 4 , and R 8 are as defined above.
  • Reaction Scheme III where R, R 2 , R 3 , and n are as defined above.
  • Reaction Scheme III is analogous to Reaction Scheme I, with a benzyloxypyridine of Formula XXVII used as the starting material in Reaction Scheme III instead of a benzyloxyaniline of Formula XV.
  • Benzyloxypyridines of Formula XXVII can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods; see for example, Holladay et al., Biorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 8, pp. 2797-2802, (1998).
  • compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme IV, where R, R 2 , R 8 , and n are defined as above; Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups; and R 3a is -Z-N(R 8 )-Q-R 4 or
  • R 8 , R 10 , Q, and R 4 as defined above; -Z-R 5 , wherein R 5 is
  • step (1) of Reaction Scheme IV the amine of an amino alcohol of Formula XXXVII is protected with a tert-butoxy carbonyl (Boc) group to provide a hydroxyalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXVIII.
  • a tert-butoxy carbonyl (Boc) group Numerous amino alcohols of Formula XXXVII are commercially available; others can be prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by treating the amino alcohol of Formula XXXVII with di-tert-butyl dicarbonate optionally in the presence of a base such as aqueous sodium hydroxide.
  • the reaction can be run at room temperature in a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran or dichloromethane.
  • a hydroxyalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXVIII is converted to an iodoalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXIX using conventional methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by treating the hydroxyalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXVIII with a solution of iodine, triphenylphosphine, and imidazole.
  • the reaction can be run at room temperature in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or solvent mixture such as diethyl ether/acetonitrile.
  • step (3) of Reaction Scheme IV a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV is treated with an iodoalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXIX to provide an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XL.
  • the reaction can be carried out according to the Williamson conditions described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • steps (4) and (5) of Reaction Scheme IV a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XL is oxidized to a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XLI, which is aminated to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLII, which is a subgenus Formulas I and II.
  • Steps (4) and (5) of Reaction Scheme IV can be carried out as described for steps (7) and (8), respectively, of Reaction Scheme I.
  • step (5) the preferred conditions for amination are the activation of an N-oxide of Formula XLI by conversion to an ester and then reacting the ester with an aminating agent.
  • Step (5) is conveniently carried out by adding ammonium hydroxide to a solution of the N-oxide of Formula XLI in a suitable solvent such as 1,2-dichloroethane and then adding p-toluenesulfonyl chloride and stirring at an elevated temperature such as 65° C.
  • step (6) of Reaction Scheme IV the Boc protecting group of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLII is removed to provide an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII, which is a subgenus of Formulas I and II.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding a solution of hydrochloric acid in ethanol to a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLII.
  • the reaction can be carried out at an elevated temperature, for example, the reflux temperature of the solvent.
  • an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII is converted to a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl compound of Formula IIa, a subgenus of Formulas I and II, using conventional methods.
  • an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII can react with an acid chloride of Formula R 4 C(O)Cl to provide a compound of Formula IIa in which R 3a is -Z-N(R 8 )—C(O)—R 4 .
  • a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII can react with sulfonyl chloride of Formula R 4 S(O) 2 Cl or a sulfonic anhydride of Formula (R 4 S(O) 2 ) 2 O to provide a compound of Formula IIa in which R 3a is -Z-N(R 8 )—S(O) 2 —R 4 .
  • Numerous acid chlorides of Formula R 4 C(O)Cl, sulfonyl chlorides of Formula R 4 S(O) 2 Cl, and sulfonic anhydrides of Formula (R 4 S(O) 2 ) 2 O are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the acid chloride of Formula R 4 C(O)Cl, sulfonyl chloride of Formula R 4 S(O) 2 Cl, or sulfonic anhydride of Formula (R 4 S(O) 2 ) 2 O to a solution of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII in a suitable solvent such as chloroform, dichloromethane, N,N-dimethylacetamide (DMA), or 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone.
  • a suitable solvent such as chloroform, dichloromethane, N,N-dimethylacetamide (DMA), or 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone.
  • a base such as triethylamine, pyridine, or N,N-diisopropylethylamine, or catalytic DMAP, or a combination thereof can be added.
  • the reaction can be carried out at room temperature or initially at a sub-ambient temperature such as 0° C. and then warming to room temperature.
  • reaction can be prepared by treating an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII, wherein R 8 is hydrogen, with a chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride of Formula Cl—R 7 S(O) 2 Cl or a chloroalkanoyl chloride of Formula C 1 —R 7 C(O)Cl.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride or chloroalkanoyl chloride to a solution of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII in a suitable solvent such as chloroform at ambient temperature.
  • the isolable intermediate chloroalkanesulfonamide or chloroalkanamide can then be treated with a base such as 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene or sodium hydride in a suitable solvent such as DMF to effect the cyclization.
  • a base such as 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene or sodium hydride in a suitable solvent such as DMF to effect the cyclization.
  • Ureas of Formula IIa where R 3a is -Z-N(R 8 )-Q-R 4 , Q is —C(R 6 )—NH—W—, R 6 is ⁇ O, and W is a bond, can be prepared by reacting an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII with isocyanates of Formula R 4 N ⁇ C ⁇ O, Numerous isocyanates of Formula R 4 N ⁇ C ⁇ O are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the isocyanate of Formula R 4 N ⁇ C ⁇ O to a solution of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane, chloroform, or DMA.
  • a base such as triethylamine can be added.
  • the reaction can be carried out at room temperature or initially at a sub-ambient temperature such as 0° C. and warming to room temperature.
  • a compound of Formula XLIII can be treated with an isocyanate of Formula R 4 (CO)N ⁇ C ⁇ O, a thioisocyanate of Formula R 4 N ⁇ C ⁇ S, a sulfonyl isocyanate of Formula R 4 S(O) 2 N ⁇ C ⁇ O, or a carbamoyl chloride of Formula R 4 N—(R 8 )—C(O)Cl,
  • Q is —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—W—, where R 6 , R 8 , and W are defined as above.
  • Sulfamides of Formula IIa where R 3a is -Z-N(R 8 )—S(O) 2 —N(R 8 )—R 4 can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XLIII with sulfuryl chloride to generate a sulfamoyl chloride in situ, and then reacting the sulfamoyl chloride with an amine of Formula HN(R 8 )R 4 .
  • sulfamides of Formula IIa can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XLIII with a sulfamoyl chloride of Formula R 4 (R 8 )N—S(O) 2 Cl.
  • Many amines of Formula HN(R 8 )R 4 and some sulfamoyl chlorides of Formula R 4 (R 8 )N—S(O) 2 Cl are commercially available; others can be prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • Compounds of Formula IIa, wherein R 3a is -Z-N(R 8 )—R 4 can be prepared by reductive alkylation of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII, wherein R 8 is hydrogen.
  • the alkylation is conveniently carried out in two parts by (i) adding an aldehyde or ketone to a solution of an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII or a salt thereof in a suitable solvent such as DMF in the presence of a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine.
  • part (ii) the reduction is carried out by adding a suitable reducing agent such as the borane-pyridine complex. Both part (i) and part (ii) can be carried out at room temperature.
  • a suitable reducing agent such as the borane-pyridine complex.
  • Both part (i) and part (ii) can be carried out at room temperature.
  • R 8 is hydrogen
  • Dimers of Formula IIa wherein R 3a is -Z-[N(R 8 )-Q]-X—[V—N(R 8 )]-X—O—R 4 , wherein X and R 8 are as defined above, Q is selected from the group consisting of —C(R 6 )—, —S(O) 2 —, —C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—, V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R 6 )—, —N(R 8 )—C(R 6 )—, and —S(O) 2 —, and R 4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R 4 above, can be prepared by treating an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII or a salt thereof with a diacid chloride, a disulfonyl chloride, or a diisocyan
  • diacid chlorides disulfonyl chlorides, and diisocyanates are commercially available. These include but are not limited to aliphatic compounds such as fumaryl chloride, succinyl chloride, glutaryl chloride, sebacoyl chloride, 2,2′-oxydiacetyl chloride, 1,4-butanedisulfonyl chloride, 1,4-diisocyanatobutane, hexamethylene diisocyanate, and 1,12-diisocyanatododecane; aromatic compounds such as 1,2-benzenedisulfonyl chloride, 1,3-benzenedisulfonyl chloride, 1,4-phenylene diisocyanate, 1,5-naphthalenediisocyanate, phthaloyl chloride, and isophthaloyl chloride; cycloaliphatic compounds such as dicylcohexylmethane-4,4′-diisocyanate, trans-1,4-cyclohe
  • Dimers of Formula IIa wherein R 3a is -Z-[N(R 8 )—C(O)—N(R 8 )]-X—O—R 4 , wherein X is as defined above, and R 4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R 4 above, can be prepared by treating an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII or a salt thereof with carbonyldiimidazole in a suitable solvent such as DMF at an elevated temperature such as 75° C.
  • a suitable solvent such as DMF
  • R, R 2 , R 10 , and n are as defined above;
  • Z a is selected from the group consisting of a bond, alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • R 3b is
  • Steps (1) through (7) of Reaction Scheme V can be run as described in steps (1) through (7) of Reaction Scheme IV to provide compounds of Formula IIb, a subgenus of Formulas I and II.
  • a compound of Formula XLV can react with a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV under the Mitsunobu reaction conditions described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV, triphenylphosphine, and tert-butyl 4-hydroxy-1-piperidinecarboxylate in THF at 5° C. or room temperature and slowly adding diisopropyl azodicarboxylate provides a compound of Formula XLVII wherein Z a is a bond and R 10 is pentylene.
  • step (4) of Reaction Scheme V can be carried out according to the reaction conditions described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme I or by heating a solution of a compound of Formula XLVII in a suitable solvent such as ethyl acetate with peracetic acid at a temperature such as 50° C. and then adding sodium metabisulfate.
  • R, R 2 , and n are as defined above;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups; and
  • R 3c is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R 4 , or -Z-Het′-Y—R 4 , wherein Het or Het′ is attached to Z at a nitrogen atom.
  • step (1) of Reaction Scheme VI a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV is treated with a dihalide of Formula I-Z-Cl or Br-Z-Cl using the Williamson conditions described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I to provide a chloro-substituted compound of Formula X.
  • a chloro-substituted compound of Formula X is treated with a cyclic secondary amine to provide a compound of Formula IIc, a subgenus of Formulas I and II.
  • cyclic secondary amines are commercially available, such as unsubstituted or substituted pyrrolidines, piperidines, morpholines, and piperazines; others can be prepared using conventional methods.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding a cyclic secondary amine to a compound of Formula X in a suitable solvent such as DMF.
  • the reaction can be conveniently carried out in the presence of a base such as potassium carbonate at an elevated temperature such as 65° C.
  • Compounds of Formula IIc are also prepared from [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinols of Formula XXV, shown in Reaction Scheme II.
  • a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV is first treated with a dihalide of Formula I-Z-Cl or Br-Z-Cl according to step (1) of Reaction Scheme V.
  • the product is then oxidized and aminated according to the methods described in steps (7) and (8) of Reaction Scheme I to provide a compound of Formula X, which is then treated with a cyclic secondary amine as described in step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI to provide a compound of Formula IIc.
  • a compound of Formula X is also a useful starting material to provide a number of other compounds of the invention.
  • a compound of Formula X can be treated with a non-cyclic secondary amine or a mercaptan under the conditions described in step (2) above to provide a compound in which R 3c is -Z-Y—R 4 , wherein R 4 is as defined above and Y is —N(R 8 )-Q- or —S—, wherein Q is a bond and R 8 is as defined above.
  • a compound of Formula X can be treated under the same conditions with a substituted phenol to provide a compound wherein R 3c is -Z-Y—X—Y—R 4 , in which the Y bonded to Z is —O—, X is phenylene, and R 4 and the Y bonded to R 4 are as defined above or a compound wherein R 3c is -Z-Y—R 4 , in which Y is —O—, and R 4 is phenyl that is optionally substituted.
  • a compound of Formula X can be treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine, in a suitable solvent such as DMF at ambient temperature.
  • the phthalimide group can then be removed from the resulting N-phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine by treatment with hydrazine at ambient temperature in a suitable solvent such as ethanol.
  • the resulting hydroxylamine can then be treated with one of numerous commercially available aldehydes or ketones in a suitable solvent such as methanol to provide a compound of Formula IIc wherein R 3c is -Z-Y—R 4 or -Z-R 5 , where Y is —O—N ⁇ C(R 4 )—, R 5 is
  • R 4 , a, b, and A′ are as defined above.
  • the hydroxylamine prepared after the hydrazine deprotection may be treated with one of numerous acid chlorides, sulfonyl chloride, isocyanates, carbamoyl chloride, or sulfamoyl chlorides using one of the methods described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV to provide a compound Formula IIc wherein R 3c is -Z-Y—R 4 where Y is —O—NH-Q-, and Q and R 4 are as defined above.
  • Compounds of the invention can also be prepared using variations of the synthetic routes shown in Reaction Schemes I through VI that would be apparent to one of skill in the art.
  • the synthetic route shown in Reaction Scheme IV for the preparation of quinolines having a R 3a substituent can be used to prepare [1,5]naphthyridines having a R 3a substituent by using a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c][1,5]naphthyridinol in lieu of the [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol.
  • Prodrugs can be prepared in a variety of ways.
  • a compound wherein R 3 or R 2 is —X—OH e.g. hydroxyalkyl
  • R 3 or R 2 is, for example, —X—O—C(R 6 )—R 4 , —X—O—C(R 6 )—O—R 4 , or —X—O—C(R 6 )—N(R 8 )—R 4 , wherein X, R 4 , R 6 , and R 8 are as defined above, using methods known to one skilled in the art.
  • a compound wherein R is hydroxy may also be converted to an ester, an ether, a carbonate, or a carbamate.
  • a prodrug can be formed by the replacement of the hydrogen atom of the alcohol group with a group such as C 1-6 alkanoyloxymethyl, 1-(C 1-6 alkanoyloxy)ethyl, 1-methyl-1-(C 1-6 alkanoyloxy)ethyl, C 1-6 alkoxycarbonyloxymethyl, N—(C 1-6 alkoxycarbonyl)aminomethyl, succinoyl, C 1-6 alkanoyl, ⁇ -aminoC 1-4 alkanoyl, arylacyl, —P(O)(OH) 2 , —P(O)(O—C 1-6 alkyl) 2 , C 1-6 alkoxycarbonyl, C 1-6 alkylcarbamoyl, and ⁇ -aminoacyl or ⁇ -
  • esters made from carboxylic acids containing one to six carbon atoms are particularly useful prodrugs.
  • unsubstituted or substituted benzoic acid esters are esters made from amino acids.
  • the reaction conditions described above in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV can be used.
  • Prodrugs can also be made from a compound containing an amino group by conversion of the amino group to a functional group such as an amide, carbamate, urea, amidine, or another hydrolyzable group using conventional methods.
  • a prodrug of this type can be made by the replacement of a hydrogen atom in an amino group, particularly the amino group at the 4-position, with a group such as —C(O)—R′, ⁇ -aminoacyl, ⁇ -aminoacyl- ⁇ -aminoacyl, —C(O)—O—R′, —C(O)—N(R′′′)—R′, —C( ⁇ NY 1 )—R′, —CH(OH)—C(O)—OY 1 , —CH(OC 1-4 alkyl)Y 0 , —CH 2 Y 2 , or —CH(CH 3 )Y 2 ; wherein R′ and R′′′ are each independently C 1-10 alkyl, C 3-7 cycloal
  • amides derived from carboxylic acids containing one to ten carbon atoms particularly useful prodrugs are amides derived from carboxylic acids containing one to ten carbon atoms, amides derived from racemic, D-, or L-amino acids, and carbamates containing one to ten carbon atoms.
  • the reaction can be carried out, for example, by combining a compound of Formula I, II, III, IV, V, or VI with a chloroformate or acid chloride, such as ethyl chloroformate or acetyl chloride, in the presence of a base such as triethylamine in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane at room temperature.
  • compositions of the invention contain a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt described above in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • a therapeutically effective amount and “effective amount” mean an amount of the compound or salt sufficient to induce a therapeutic or prophylactic effect, such as cytokine induction, immunomodulation, antitumor activity, and/or antiviral activity.
  • cytokine induction cytokine induction
  • immunomodulation antitumor activity
  • antiviral activity cytokine induction
  • amount of compound or salt used in a pharmaceutical composition of the invention will vary according to factors known to those of skill in the art, such as the physical and chemical nature of the compound or salt, the nature of the carrier, and the intended dosing regimen.
  • compositions of the invention will contain sufficient active ingredient or prodrug to provide a dose of about 100 nanograms per kilogram (ng/kg) to about 50 milligrams per kilogram (mg/kg), preferably about 10 micrograms per kilogram ( ⁇ g/kg) to about 5 mg/kg, of the compound or salt to the subject.
  • the method includes administering sufficient compound to provide a dose of from about 0.1 mg/m 2 to about 2.0 mg/m 2 to the subject, for example, a dose of from about 0.4 mg/m 2 to about 1.2 mg/m 2 .
  • dosage forms such as tablets, lozenges, capsules, parenteral formulations, syrups, creams, ointments, aerosol formulations, transdermal patches, transmucosal patches and the like.
  • These dosage forms can be prepared with conventional pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and additives using conventional methods, which generally include the step of bringing the active ingredient into association with the carrier.
  • the compounds or salts of the invention can be administered as the single therapeutic agent in the treatment regimen, or the compounds or salts described herein may be administered in combination with one another or with other active agents, including additional immune response modifiers, antivirals, antibiotics, antibodies, proteins, peptides, oligonucleotides, etc.
  • Cytokines whose production may be induced by the administration of compounds or salts of the invention generally include interferon- ⁇ (IFN- ⁇ ) and tumor necrosis factor- ⁇ (TNF- ⁇ ) as well as certain interleukins (IL). Cytokines whose biosynthesis may be induced by compounds or salts of the invention include IFN- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , IL-1, IL-6, IL-10 and IL-12, and a variety of other cytokines. Among other effects, these and other cytokines can inhibit virus production and tumor cell growth, making the compounds or salts useful in the treatment of viral diseases and neoplastic diseases.
  • IFN- ⁇ interferon- ⁇
  • TNF- ⁇ tumor necrosis factor- ⁇
  • IL-12 interleukins
  • the invention provides a method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal.
  • the animal to which the compound or salt is administered for induction of cytokine biosynthesis may have a disease as described infra, for example a viral disease or a neoplastic disease, and administration of the compound or salt may provide therapeutic treatment.
  • the compound or salt may be administered to the animal prior to the animal acquiring the disease so that administration of the compound or salt may provide a prophylactic treatment.
  • compounds or salts described herein can affect other aspects of the innate immune response. For example, natural killer cell activity may be stimulated, an effect that may be due to cytokine induction.
  • the compounds or salts may also activate macrophages, which in turn stimulate secretion of nitric oxide and the production of additional cytokines. Further, the compounds or salts may cause proliferation and differentiation of B-lymphocytes.
  • T H 1 T helper type 1
  • T H 2 T helper type 2
  • the compound or salt or composition may be administered alone or in combination with one or more active components as in, for example, a vaccine adjuvant.
  • the compound or salt or composition and other component or components may be administered separately; together but independently such as in a solution; or together and associated with one another such as (a) covalently linked or (b) non-covalently associated, e.g., in a colloidal suspension.
  • Conditions for which compounds or salts or compositions identified herein may be used as treatments include, but are not limited to:
  • viral diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by an adenovirus, a herpesvirus (e.g., HSV-I, HSV-II, CMV, or VZV), a poxvirus (e.g., an orthopoxvirus such as variola or vaccinia, or molluscum contagiosum), a picornavirus (e.g., rhinovirus or enterovirus), an orthomyxovirus (e.g., influenzavirus), a paramyxovirus (e.g., parainfluenzavirus, mumps virus, measles virus, and respiratory syncytial virus (RSV)), a coronavirus (e.g., SARS), a papovavirus (e.g., papillomaviruses, such as those that cause genital warts, common warts, or plantar warts), a hepadnavirus (e.g., hepatitis B virus),
  • bacterial diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by bacteria of, for example, the genus Escherichia, Enterobacter, Salmonella, Staphylococcus, Shigella, Listeria, Aerobacter, Helicobacter, Klebsiella, Proteus, Pseudomonas, Streptococcus, Chlamydia, Mycoplasma, Pneumococcus, Neisseria, Clostridium, Bacillus, Corynebacterium, Mycobacterium, Campylobacter, Vibrio, Serratia, Providencia, Chromobacterium, Brucella, Yersinia, Haemophilus , or Bordetella;
  • infectious diseases such as chlamydia, fungal diseases including but not limited to candidiasis, aspergillosis, histoplasmosis, cryptococcal meningitis, or parasitic diseases including but not limited to malaria, pneumocystis carnii pneumonia, leishmaniasis, cryptosporidiosis, toxoplasmosis, and trypanosome infection;
  • neoplastic diseases such as intraepithelial neoplasias, cervical dysplasia, actinic keratosis, basal cell carcinoma, squamous cell carcinoma, renal cell carcinoma, Kaposi's sarcoma, melanoma, leukemias including but not limited to acute myeloid leukemia, acute lymphocytic leukemia, chronic myeloid leukemia, chronic lymphocytic leukemia, multiple myeloma, Hodgkin's lymphoma, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, cutaneous T-cell lymphoma, B-cell lymphoma, and hairy cell leukemia, and other cancers;
  • atopic diseases such as atopic dermatitis or eczema, eosinophilia, asthma, allergy, allergic rhinitis, and Ommen's syndrome;
  • diseases associated with wound repair such as, for example, inhibition of keloid formation and other types of scarring (e.g., enhancing wound healing, including chronic wounds).
  • a compound or salt identified herein may be useful as a vaccine adjuvant for use in conjunction with any material that raises either humoral and/or cell mediated immune response, such as, for example, live viral, bacterial, or parasitic immunogens; inactivated viral, tumor-derived, protozoal, organism-derived, fungal, or bacterial immunogens; toxoids; toxins; self-antigens; polysaccharides; proteins; glycoproteins; peptides; cellular vaccines; DNA vaccines; autologous vaccines; recombinant proteins; and the like, for use in connection with, for example, BCG, cholera, plague, typhoid, hepatitis A, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, influenza A, influenza B, parainfluenza, polio, rabies, measles, mumps, rubella, yellow fever, tetanus, diphtheria, hemophilus influenza b, tuberculosis, meningo
  • Compounds or salts identified herein may be particularly helpful in individuals having compromised immune function.
  • compounds or salts may be used for treating the opportunistic infections and tumors that occur after suppression of cell mediated immunity in, for example, transplant patients, cancer patients and HIV patients.
  • one or more of the above diseases or types of diseases for example, a viral disease or a neoplastic disease may be treated in an animal in need thereof (having the disease) by administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal.
  • An animal may also be vaccinated by administering an effective amount of a compound or salt described herein, as a vaccine adjuvant.
  • a method of vaccinating an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt described herein to the animal as a vaccine adjuvant.
  • An amount of a compound or salt effective to induce cytokine biosynthesis is an amount sufficient to cause one or more cell types, such as monocytes, macrophages, dendritic cells and B-cells to produce an amount of one or more cytokines such as, for example, IFN- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ , IL-1, IL-6, IL-10 and IL-12 that is increased (induced) over a background level of such cytokines.
  • the precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 ⁇ g/kg to about 5 mg/kg.
  • the amount is expected to be a dose of, for example, from about 0.01 mg/m 2 to about 5.0 mg/m 2 , (computed according to the Dubois method as described above) although in some embodiments the induction or inhibition of cytokine biosynthesis may be performed by administering a compound or salt in a dose outside this range.
  • the method includes administering sufficient compound or salt or composition to provide a dose of from about 0.1 mg/m 2 to about 2.0 mg/m 2 to the subject, for example, a dose of from about 0.4 mg/m 2 to about 1.2 mg/m 2 .
  • the invention also provides a method of treating a viral infection in an animal and a method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal.
  • An amount effective to treat or inhibit a viral infection is an amount that will cause a reduction in one or more of the manifestations of viral infection, such as viral lesions, viral load, rate of virus production, and mortality as compared to untreated control animals.
  • the precise amount that is effective for such treatment will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 ⁇ g/kg to about 5 mg/kg.
  • An amount of a compound or salt effective to treat a neoplastic condition is an amount that will cause a reduction in tumor size or in the number of tumor foci. Again, the precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 ⁇ g/kg to about 5 mg/kg. In other embodiments, the amount is expected to be a dose of, for example, from about 0.01 mg/m 2 to about 5.0 mg/m 2 , (computed according to the Dubois method as described above) although in some embodiments either of these methods may be performed by administering a compound or salt in a dose outside this range.
  • the method includes administering sufficient compound or salt to provide a dose of from about 0.1 mg/m 2 to about 2.0 mg/m 2 to the subject, for example, a dose of from about 0.4 mg/m 2 to about 1.2 mg/m 2 .
  • the organic layer was washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resulting dark brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (an automated, modular high-performance flash purification product available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Va., USA) (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 30% 80:18:2 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide (CMA) in chloroform) to provide 0.48 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum.
  • HORIZON HPFC system an automated, modular high-performance flash purification product available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Va., USA
  • the solid was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (30 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 0.32 g of 7-(2-morpholin-4-ylethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as light yellow needles, mp 122-125° C.
  • the method described in Part K of Example 1 was used to treat the material from Part J of Example 1 (5.40 mmol) in DMF (25 mL) with cesium carbonate (11.00 g, 33.75 mmol) and 1-(2-chloroethyl)pyrrolidine hydrochloride (1.15 g, 6.75 mmol) with the modification that the reaction was carried out at 70° C. instead of 75° C.
  • the purification methods described in Part K of Example 1 were used to provide 0.33 g of 2-propyl-7-(2-pyrrolidin-1-ylethoxy)[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as light yellow needles, mp 124-127° C.
  • the filtrate was washed sequentially with water (2 ⁇ 500 mL), saturated aqueous sodium thiosulfate (2 ⁇ 250 mL), water (250 mL), and brine (250 mL); dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide a mixture of a yellow oil and a white solid.
  • the mixture was diluted with heptane (50 mL) and filtered to remove the solid, which was washed with heptane (50 mL).
  • the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide an oil that was diluted with heptane (50 mL) and filtered to remove a solid, which was washed with heptane (50 mL).
  • the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 22.60 g of tert-butyl 3-iodopropylcarbamate as a yellow oil containing about 9 mol % triphenylphosphine oxide as determined by 1 H NMR.
  • the resulting mixture was washed with aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ⁇ 50 mL of 2 M), and the combined washings were extracted with dichloromethane (2 ⁇ 50 mL).
  • the combined organic layers were washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resulting light brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 18% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.72 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum.
  • the solid was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (40 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 40° C. overnight to provide tert-butyl 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate as off-white needles, mp 146-149° C.
  • aqueous fraction was made basic with the addition of ammonium hydroxide, and the resulting solution was extracted with dichloromethane (2 ⁇ 50 mL). The organic fractions were combined, washed with brine (75 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 0.58 g of 7-(3-aminopropoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine containing some impurities.
  • Methanesulfonyl chloride (0.14 mL, 1.8 mmol) was added, and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 5.5 hours. The reaction was monitored by HPLC, and additional methanesulfonyl chloride (0.84 mL, 11 mmol) was added over the course of four days. The reaction mixture was partitioned between chloroform (50 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic fraction was washed with brine (2 ⁇ 50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.17 g of N- ⁇ 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propyl ⁇ methanesulfonamide as off-white needles, mp 168-171° C.
  • the reaction was stirred for two hours and then mixed with water (100 mL).
  • the aqueous fraction was extracted with chloroform (2 ⁇ 100 mL), and the combined organic fractions were washed with brine (100 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 1.17 g of N- ⁇ 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propyl ⁇ -5-(dimethylamino)naphthalene-1-sulfonamide as a light yellow solid, mp 143-146° C.
  • the resulting light brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 5% CMA in chloroform followed by 25% CMA in chloroform) to provide 1.88 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum.
  • the solid was recrystallized from 2-propanol (175 mL), and the crystals were washed with cold 2-propanol and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 1.54 g of 7-(2-morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as white needles, mp 200-203° C.
  • the resulting light yellow oil (19.36 g) was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, eluting with dichloromethane) to provide 13.53 g of tert-butyl 6-iodohexylcarbamate as a light yellow oil.
  • the organic layer was washed sequentially with saturated aqueous sodium thiosulfate (50 mL), water (50 mL), and brine (50 mL); dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resulting solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 6% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 1.79 g of tert-butyl 6-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • the resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.47 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum.
  • the solid was recrystallized from toluene (25 mL), and the crystals were washed with cold toluene and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.32 g of N- ⁇ 6-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexyl ⁇ methanesulfonamide as off-white needles, mp 138-134° C.
  • the resulting solid was partitioned between dichloromethane (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the resulting dark brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 8% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 1.31 g of tert-butyl 2- ⁇ 2-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy ⁇ ethylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • mCPBA (1.20 g, 4.30 mmol, 65% pure) was added in portions to a solution of tert-butyl 2- ⁇ 2-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy ⁇ ethylcarbamate (1.25 g, 2.90 mmol) in dichloromethane (75 mL), and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 1.75 hours, diluted with chloroform (100 mL), and washed with 10% aqueous sodium carbonate (2 ⁇ 50 mL).
  • the resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.73 g of an off-white solid after drying under high vacuum.
  • the solid was recrystallized from propyl acetate (35 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold propyl acetate and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.48 g of N- ⁇ 2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl ⁇ methanesulfonamide as light yellow needles, mp 148-151° C.
  • the method described in Part K of Example 1 was used to treat 4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol acetic acid salt (prepared according to the method described in Part J of Example 1, 1.17 g, 4.51 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) with cesium carbonate (3.27 g, 10.0 mmol) and 2-chloroethylether (288 mg, 2.01 mmol) with the modification that the reaction was carried out at 70° C. instead of 75° C.
  • the purification methods described in Part K of Example 1 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform.
  • the crude solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.93 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum.
  • the solid was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (35 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 0.23 g of 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a light yellow solid, mp 101-103° C.
  • a reagent from the table below (1.1 equivalents, 0.11 mmol) was added to a test tube containing a solution of 7-[2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (prepared as described in Part A of Example 11, 35 mg, 0.10 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (36 ⁇ L, 0.20 mmol) in N,N-dimethylacetamide (DMA) (1 mL).
  • DMA N,N-dimethylacetamide
  • the compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep HPLC) using a Waters FractionLynx automated purification system.
  • the prep HPLC fractions were analyzed using a Waters LC/TOF-MS, and the appropriate fractions were centrifuge evaporated to provide the trifluoroacetate salt of the desired compound.
  • Reversed phase prep HPLC was performed with non-linear gradient elution from 5-95% B where A is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/water and B is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/acetonitrile. Fractions were collected by mass-selective triggering.
  • the table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, isocyanate, isothiocyanate, or carbamoyl chloride used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • the DMF was removed under reduced pressure at 65° C., and the residue was partitioned between chloroform (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was separated and washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure.
  • the crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from propyl acetate (25 mL for 0.35 g). The crystals were washed with cold propyl acetate and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C.
  • Example 102 After the work-up procedure, described in Example 102, the crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 28% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile (50 mL for 0.67 g). The crystals were washed with cold acetonitrile and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.426 g of N- ⁇ 2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl ⁇ acrylamide as a light yellow solid, mp 200-202° C.
  • HORIZON HPFC system sica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 28% CMA in chloroform
  • the crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile (25 mL for 0.37 g).
  • the crystals were washed with cold acetonitrile and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 290 mg of N- ⁇ 2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl ⁇ pyrrolidin-2-one as a light yellow solid, mp 163-166° C.
  • a Parr vessel was charged with 7-benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-7-ol (50.0 g, 169 mmol), anhydrous DMF (500 mL), and 5% platinum on carbon (5.0 g). The vessel was placed on Parr apparatus, evacuated, and charged with hydrogen gas (approximately 45 psi, 3.1 ⁇ 10 5 Pa). The reaction mixture was shaken overnight and filtered to remove the catalyst. To the resulting dark colored solution was added concentrated aqueous hydrochloric acid (14 mL of 12 N solution). A precipitate formed, and the reaction mixture was stirred over the weekend. The solid was collected by vacuum filtration, washed with diethyl ether (100 mL), and air-dried overnight to provide 44 g of 3-amino-7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol hydrochloride.
  • Trichloroacetyl isocyanate (5.6 mL, 46.8 mmol) was slowly added to a vigorously stirred pale orange solution of 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl-5-oxido[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (15.0 g, 44.6 mmol) in dichloromethane (200 mL) at room temperature. The solution was maintained at room temperature for 18 hours, and then concentrated ammonium hydroxide solution (60 mL) was added. An off-white precipitate formed and was collected by vacuum filtration.
  • the residue was dissolved in chloroform and purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (eluting with a gradient of 0% to 20% CMA in chloroform over 700 mL and then with 20% CMA in chloroform for 600 mL).
  • the major product isolated from the column fractions was 7-(3-azidopropoxy)-2-ethylthiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (400 mg).
  • a second product isolated from the column was triturated with hot acetonitrile containing a small amount of methanol, and the mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature.
  • mCPBA (1.97 g of 70% pure material, 11 mmol) was added to a solution of tert-butyl 4-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate (3.76 g, 8.79 mmol), and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 1.5 hours. An analysis by LC/MS indicated the presence of starting material, and additional mCPBA (250 mg) was added.
  • reaction was stirred at room temperature for an additional 1.5 hours; diluted with chloroform (20 mL); washed sequentially with aqueous sodium carbonate (20 mL of 10% w/w), water (20 mL), and brine (20 mL); dried over sodium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide tert-butyl 4-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate as a light yellow solid.
  • a solution of the material from Part C in 1,2-dichloroethane (60 mL) was heated to 65° C. in a pressure vessel.
  • Aqueous ammonium hydroxide (20 mL of 30% w/w) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.76 g, 9.23 mmol) were quickly added, and the vessel was sealed and heated at 70° C. for 15 hours and allowed to cool to room temperature.
  • the organic layer was separated and washed sequentially with aqueous sodium carbonate (20 mL of 10% w/w) and water (20 mL).
  • the combined aqueous fractions were extracted with chloroform (20 mL).
  • the solid was suspended in a small volume of water, and the suspension was cooled to approximately 0° C. and adjusted to approximately pH 10 with the addition of 50% w/w aqueous sodium hydroxide. A yellow precipitate formed and was collected by filtration, washed with water, and dried overnight under vacuum.
  • the solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0% to 15% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile. The crystals were dried to provide 7-(piperidin-4-yloxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as yellow crystals.
  • Certain exemplary compounds including some of those described above in the Examples, have the following Formula (IId) and the following Z, R 3d , and R 2 , substituents, wherein each line of the table is matched with Formula IId to represent a specific embodiment of the invention.
  • R 3d R 2 —CH 2 CH 2 — (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl —CH 2 CH 2 — (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl —CH 2 CH 2 — (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl —CH 2 CH 2 — (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl —CH 2 CH 2 — (methylsulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl —CH 2 CH 2 — pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl —CH 2 CH 2 — pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl —CH 2 CH 2 — pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl —CH 2 CH 2 — pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl —CH 2 CH 2 — pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl —CH 2 CH 2 — morpholin-4-yl
  • Certain exemplary compounds including some of those described above in the Examples, have the following Formula (IIe) and the following Z, R 3e , and R 2 , substituents, wherein each line of the table is matched with Formula IIe to represent a specific embodiment of the invention.
  • Compounds of the invention have been found to modulate cytokine biosynthesis by inducing the production of interferon ⁇ and/or tumor necrosis factor a in human cells when tested using one of the methods described below.
  • cytokine induction An in vitro human blood cell system is used to assess cytokine induction. Activity is based on the measurement of interferon ( ⁇ ) and tumor necrosis factor ( ⁇ ) (IFN- ⁇ and TNF- ⁇ , respectively) secreted into culture media as described by Testerman et. al. in “Cytokine Induction by the Immunomodulators Imiquimod and S-27609”, Journal of Leukocyte Biology, 58, 365-372 (September, 1995).
  • interferon
  • tumor necrosis factor
  • PBMC Peripheral blood mononuclear cells
  • HISTOPAQUE-1077 Sigma, St. Louis, Mo.
  • Ficoll-Paque Plus Amersham Biosciences Piscataway, N.J.
  • Blood is diluted 1:1 with Dulbecco's Phosphate Buffered Saline (DPBS) or Hank's Balanced Salts Solution (HBSS).
  • DPBS Dulbecco's Phosphate Buffered Saline
  • HBSS Hank's Balanced Salts Solution
  • PBMC whole blood is placed in Accuspin (Sigma) or LeucoSep (Greiner Bio-One, Inc., Longwood, Fla.) centrifuge frit tubes containing density gradient medium.
  • the PBMC layer is collected and washed twice with DPBS or HBSS and re-suspended at 4 ⁇ 10 6 cells/mL in RPMI complete.
  • the PBMC suspension is added to 96 well flat bottom sterile tissue culture plates containing an equal volume of RPMI complete media containing test compound.
  • the compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO).
  • DMSO concentration should not exceed a final concentration of 1% for addition to the culture wells.
  • the compounds are generally tested at concentrations ranging from 30-0.014 ⁇ M. Controls include cell samples with media only, cell samples with DMSO only (no compound), and cell samples with reference compound.
  • test compound is added at 60 ⁇ M to the first well containing RPMI complete and serial 3 fold dilutions are made in the wells.
  • the PBMC suspension is then added to the wells in an equal volume, bringing the test compound concentrations to the desired range (usually 30-0.014 ⁇ M).
  • the final concentration of PBMC suspension is 2 ⁇ 10 6 cells/mL.
  • the plates are covered with sterile plastic lids, mixed gently and then incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37° C. in a 5% carbon dioxide atmosphere.
  • IFN- ⁇ concentration is determined with a human multi-subtype colorimetric sandwich ELISA (Catalog Number 41105) from PBL Biomedical Laboratories, Piscataway, N.J. Results are expressed in pg/mL.
  • TNF- ⁇ concentration is determined by ORIGEN M-Series Immunoassay and read on an IGEN M-8 analyzer from BioVeris Corporation, formerly known as IGEN
  • the immunoassay uses a human TNF- ⁇ capture and detection antibody pair (Catalog Numbers AHC3419 and AHC3712) from Biosource International, Camarillo, Calif. Results are expressed in pg/mL.
  • the data output of the assay consists of concentration values of TNF- ⁇ and IFN- ⁇ (y-axis) as a function of compound concentration (x-axis).
  • the reference compound used is 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- ⁇ , ⁇ -dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91) and the expected area is the sum of the median dose values from the past 61 experiments.
  • the minimum effective concentration is calculated based on the background-subtracted, reference-adjusted results for a given experiment and compound.
  • the minimum effective concentration ( ⁇ molar) is the lowest of the tested compound concentrations that induces a response over a fixed cytokine concentration for the tested cytokine (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN- ⁇ and 40 pg/mL for TNF- ⁇ ).
  • the maximal response is the maximal amount of cytokine (pg/ml) produced in the dose-response.
  • the CYTOKINE INDUCTION IN HUMAN CELLS test method described above was modified as follows for high throughput screening.
  • PBMC Peripheral blood mononuclear cells
  • HISTOPAQUE-1077 Sigma, St. Louis, Mo.
  • Ficoll-Paque Plus Amersham Biosciences Piscataway, N.J.
  • Whole blood is placed in Accuspin (Sigma) or LeucoSep (Greiner Bio-One, Inc., Longwood, Fla.) centrifuge frit tubes containing density gradient medium.
  • the PBMC layer is collected and washed twice with DPBS or HBSS and re-suspended at 4 ⁇ 10 6 cells/mL in RPMI complete (2-fold the final cell density).
  • the PBMC suspension is added to 96-well flat bottom sterile tissue culture plates.
  • the compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO).
  • DMSO dimethyl sulfoxide
  • Controls include cell samples with media only, cell samples with DMSO only (no compound), and cell samples with a reference compound 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- ⁇ , ⁇ -dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91) on each plate.
  • the solution of test compound is added at 7.5 mM to the first well of a dosing plate and serial 3 fold dilutions are made for the 7 subsequent concentrations in DMSO.
  • RPMI Complete media is then added to the test compound dilutions in order to reach a final compound concentration of 2-fold higher (60-0.028 ⁇ M) than the final tested concentration range.
  • test compound solution is then added to the wells containing the PBMC suspension bringing the test compound concentrations to the desired range (usually 30-0.014 ⁇ M) and the DMSO concentration to 0.4%.
  • the final concentration of PBMC suspension is 2 ⁇ 10 6 cells/mL.
  • the plates are covered with sterile plastic lids, mixed gently and then incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37° C. in a 5% carbon dioxide atmosphere.
  • MSD MULTI-SPOT plates contain within each well capture antibodies for human TNF- ⁇ and human IFN- ⁇ that have been pre-coated on specific spots. Each well contains four spots: one human TNF- ⁇ capture antibody (MSD) spot, one human IFN- ⁇ capture antibody (PBL Biomedical Laboratories, Piscataway, N.J.) spot, and two inactive bovine serum albumin spots.
  • the human TNF- ⁇ capture and detection antibody pair is from MesoScale Discovery.
  • the human IFN- ⁇ multi-subtype antibody (PBL Biomedical Laboratories) captures all IFN- ⁇ subtypes except IFN- ⁇ F (IFN ⁇ 21).
  • Standards consist of recombinant human TNF- ⁇ (R&D Systems, Minneapolis, Minn.) and IFN- ⁇ (PBL Biomedical Laboratories). Samples and separate standards are added at the time of analysis to each MSD plate. Two human IFN- ⁇ detection antibodies (Cat. Nos. 21112 & 21100, PBL) are used in a two to one ratio (weight:weight) to each other to determine the IFN- ⁇ concentrations.
  • the cytokine-specific detection antibodies are labeled with the SULFO-TAG reagent (MSD). After adding the SULFO-TAG labeled detection antibodies to the wells, each well's electrochemoluminescent levels are read using MSD's SECTOR HTS READER. Results are expressed in pg/mL upon calculation with known cytokine standards.
  • the data output of the assay consists of concentration values of TNF- ⁇ or IFN- ⁇ (y-axis) as a function of compound concentration (x-axis).
  • a plate-wise scaling is performed within a given experiment aimed at reducing plate-to-plate variability associated within the same experiment.
  • the greater of the median DMSO (DMSO control wells) or the experimental background (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN- ⁇ and 40 pg/mL for TNF- ⁇ ) is subtracted from each reading. Negative values that may result from background subtraction are set to zero.
  • Each plate within a given experiment has a reference compound that serves as a control. This control is used to calculate a median expected area under the curve across all plates in the assay.
  • a plate-wise scaling factor is calculated for each plate as a ratio of the area of the reference compound on the particular plate to the median expected area for the entire experiment.
  • the data from each plate are then multiplied by the plate-wise scaling factor for all plates. Only data from plates bearing a scaling factor of between 0.5 and 2.0 (for both cytokines IFN- ⁇ , TNF- ⁇ ) are reported. Data from plates with scaling factors outside the above mentioned interval are retested until they bear scaling factors inside the above mentioned interval. The above method produces a scaling of the y-values without altering the shape of the curve.
  • the reference compound used is 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- ⁇ , ⁇ -dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91).
  • the median expected area is the median area across all plates that are part of a given experiment.
  • a second scaling may also be performed to reduce inter-experiment variability (across multiple experiments). All background-subtracted values are multiplied by a single adjustment ratio to decrease experiment-to-experiment variability.
  • the adjustment ratio is the area of the reference compound in the new experiment divided by the expected area of the reference compound based on an average of previous experiments (unadjusted readings). This results in the scaling of the reading (y-axis) for the new data without changing the shape of the dose-response curve.
  • the reference compound used is 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro- ⁇ , ⁇ -dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91) and the expected area is the sum of the median dose values from an average of previous experiments.
  • the minimum effective concentration is calculated based on the background-subtracted, reference-adjusted results for a given experiment and compound.
  • the minimum effective concentration ( ⁇ molar) is the lowest of the tested compound concentrations that induces a response over a fixed cytokine concentration for the tested cytokine (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN- ⁇ and 40 pg/mL for TNF- ⁇ ).
  • the maximal response is the maximal amount of cytokine (pg/ml) produced in the dose-response.

Abstract

Thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines with an alkoxy substituent at the 6, 7, 8, or 9-position, pharmaceutical compositions containing the compounds, intermediates, methods of making and methods of use of these compounds as immunomodulators, for inducing cytokine biosynthesis in animals and in the treatment of diseases including viral and neoplastic diseases are disclosed.

Description

    CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • The present invention claims priority to U.S. Provisional Application Ser. No. 60/651,585, filed Feb. 9, 2005, and U.S. Provisional Application Ser. No. 60/733,036, filed Nov. 3, 2005, both of which are incorporated herein by reference.
  • BACKGROUND
  • Certain compounds have been found to be useful as immune response modifiers (IRMs), rendering them useful in the treatment of a variety of disorders. However, there continues to be interest in and a need for compounds that have the ability to modulate the immune response, by induction of cytokine biosynthesis or other mechanisms.
  • SUMMARY
  • The present invention provides a new class of compounds that are useful in inducing cytokine biosynthesis in animals. Such compounds are of the following Formula I:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00001
  • wherein RA, RB, and R″ are as defined below.
  • The compounds of Formula I are useful as immune response modifiers due to their ability to induce cytokine biosynthesis (e.g., induces the synthesis of at least one cytokine) and otherwise modulate the immune response when administered to animals. This makes the compounds useful in the treatment of a variety of conditions such as viral diseases and tumors that are responsive to such changes in the immune response.
  • The invention further provides pharmaceutical compositions containing an effective amount of a compound of Formula I and methods of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal, treating a viral infection or disease and/or treating a neoplastic disease in an animal by administering an effective amount of a compound of Formula I to the animal.
  • In addition, methods of synthesizing compounds of Formula I and intermediates useful in the synthesis of these compounds are provided.
  • As used herein, “a”, “an”, “the”, “at least one”, and “one or more” are used interchangeably.
  • The terms “comprises” and variations thereof do not have a limiting meaning where these terms appear in the description and claims.
  • The above summary of the present invention is not intended to describe each disclosed embodiment or every implementation of the present invention. The description that follows more particularly exemplifies illustrative embodiments. In several places throughout the description, guidance is provided through lists of examples, which examples can be used in various combinations. In each instance, the recited list serves only as a representative group and should not be interpreted as an exclusive list.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF ILLUSTRATIVE EMBODIMENTS OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention provides compounds of the following Formulas I through VII:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00002
  • as well as intermediates of the following Formulas X through XIII:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00003
  • wherein RA, RB, R″, R, R2, R3, n, G, and Z are as defined below.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides a compound of Formula I:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00004
  • wherein:
  • RA and RB taken together form a fused benzene ring or fused pyridine ring wherein the benzene ring or pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group, or substituted by one —O—R3 group and one R group;
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • -Z-Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y-x-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-R5,
      • -Z-Het,
      • -Z-Het′-R4, and
      • -Z-Het′-Y—R4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • R″ is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R9)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O —C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
      • —O—N(R8)-Q-,
      • —O—N═C(R4)—,
      • —C(═N—O—R8)—,
      • —CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00005
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, diallylamino, (diallylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00006
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)O0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
      • R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
      • R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00007
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00008
  • or
      • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00009
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00010
  • and
  • with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
      • Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
      • Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides a compound of Formula II:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00011
  • wherein:
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • -Z-Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-R5,
  • -Z-Het,
      • -Z-Het′-R4, and
      • -Z-Het′-Y—R4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • n is 0 or 1;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
      • —O—N(R8)-Q-,
      • —O—N═C(R4)—,
      • —C(═N—O—R8)—,
      • —CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00012
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00013
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00014
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00015
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
      • R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
      • R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00016
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00017
  • or
      • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00018
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—,
    or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00019
  • and
  • with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
      • Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
      • Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides a compound selected from the group consisting Formulas III, IV, V, and VI:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00020
  • wherein:
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • -Z-Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-R5,
      • -Z-Het,
      • -Z-Het′-R4, and
      • -Z-Het′-Y—R4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • n is 0 or 1;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
      • O—N(R8)-Q-,
      • —O—N═C(R4)—,
      • —C(═N—O—R8)—,
      • —CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00021
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00022
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00023
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00024
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
      • R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
      • R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00025
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00026
  • or
      • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00027
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00028
  • and
  • with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
      • Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
      • Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene; or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides a compound (which is a prodrug) of Formula VII:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00029
  • wherein:
  • RA and RB taken together form a fused benzene ring or fused pyridine ring wherein the benzene ring or pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group, or substituted by one —O—R3 group and one R group;
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • -Z-Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-R5,
      • -Z-Het,
      • -Z-Het′-R4, and
      • -Z-Het′-Y—R4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • G is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —C(O)—R′,
      • α-aminoacyl,
      • α-aminoacyl-α-aminoacyl,
      • —C(O)—O—R′,
      • —C(O)—N(R′″)R′,
      • C(—NY1)—R′,
      • —CH(OH)—C(O)—OY1,
      • —CH(OC1-4 alkyl)Y0,
      • —CH2Y2, and
      • —CH(CH3)Y2;
  • R′ and R′″ are independently selected from the group consisting of C1-10 alkyl, C3-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, and benzyl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, nitro, cyano, carboxy, C1-6 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, aryl-C1-4 alkylenyl, heteroaryl-C1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C1-4 alkoxy, —O—C(O)—CH3, —C(O)—O—CH3, —C(O)—NH2, —O—CH2—C(O)—NH2, —NH2, and —S(O)2—NH2, with the proviso that R′″ can also be hydrogen;
  • α-aminoacyl is an α-aminoacyl group derived from an amino acid selected from the group consisting of racemic, D-, and L-amino acids;
  • Y1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, and benzyl;
  • Y0 is selected from the group consisting of C1-6 alkyl, carboxy-C1-6 alkylenyl, amino-C1-4 alkylenyl, mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino-C1-4 alkylenyl, and di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino-C1-4 alkylenyl;
  • Y2 is selected from the group consisting of mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino, di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino, morpholin-4-yl, piperidin-1-yl, pyrrolidin-1-yl, and 4-C1-4 alkylpiperazin-1-yl;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
      • —O—N(R8)-Q-,
      • —O—N═C(R4)—,
      • —C(═N—O—R8)—,
      • —CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00030
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00031
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00032
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00033
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)O0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
      • R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
      • R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00034
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00035
  • or
      • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00036
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00037
  • and
  • with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
      • Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
      • Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula X, which is also an IRM:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00038
  • wherein:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • n is 0 or 1;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R9)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00039
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00040
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula XI, which is also an IRM:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00041
  • wherein:
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • n is 0 or 1;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00042
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00043
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula XII:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00044
  • wherein:
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • -Z-Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-R5,
      • -Z-Het,
      • -Z-Het′-R4, and
      • -Z-Het′-Y—R4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • n is 0 or 1;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
      • —O—N(R8)-Q-,
      • —O—N═C(R4)—,
      • —C(═N—O—R8)—,
      • —CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00045
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R9)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00046
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00047
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00048
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
      • R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
      • R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00049
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00050
  • or
      • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00051
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00052
  • and
  • with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
      • Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
      • Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the present invention provides an intermediate compound of Formula XIII:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00053
  • wherein:
  • R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • -Z-Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
      • -Z-R5,
      • -Z-Het,
      • -Z-Het′-R4, and
      • -Z-Het′-Y—R4;
  • R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
  • n is 0or 1;
  • R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —R4,
      • —X—R4,
      • —X—Y′—R4, and
      • —X—R5′;
  • Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
  • Y is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
      • —O—N(R8)-Q-,
      • —O—N═C(R4)—,
      • —C(═N—O—R8)—,
      • —CH(—N(—O —R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00054
  • Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
  • X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
  • Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
      • —O—,
      • —S(O)0-2—,
      • —S(O)2—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—,
      • —C(R6)—O—,
      • —O—C(R6)—,
      • —O—C(O)—O—,
      • —N(R8)-Q-,
      • —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
      • —C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00055
  • R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alklylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
  • R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00056
  • R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00057
  • R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
  • R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
  • R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
  • R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
  • R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
  • A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
  • A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—-, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
  • Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
  • V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R9)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
  • W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
  • a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
  • with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
      • R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
      • R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00058
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00059
  • or
      • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00060
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00061
  • and
  • with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
      • Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
      • Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
        or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • Herein, “non-interfering” means that the ability of the compound or salt, which includes a non-interfering substituent, to modulate the biosynthesis of one or more cytokines is not destroyed by the non-interfering substituent. Illustrative non-interfering R″ groups include those described above for R2.
  • As used herein, the terms “alkyl”, “alkenyl”, “alkynyl” and the prefix “alk-” are inclusive of both straight chain and branched chain groups and of cyclic groups, e.g., cycloalkyl and cycloalkenyl. Unless otherwise specified, these groups contain from 1 to carbon atoms, with alkenyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms, and alkynyl groups containing from 2 to 20 carbon atoms. In some embodiments, these groups have a total of up to 10 carbon atoms, up to 8 carbon atoms, up to 6 carbon atoms, or up to 4 carbon atoms. Cyclic groups can be monocyclic or polycyclic and preferably have from 3 to 10 ring carbon atoms. Exemplary cyclic groups include cyclopropyl, cyclopropylmethyl, cyclobutyl, cyclobutylmethyl, cyclopentyl, cyclopentylmethyl, cyclohexyl, cyclohexylmethyl, adamantyl, and substituted and unsubstituted bornyl, norbornyl, and norbornenyl.
  • Unless otherwise specified, “alkylene”, “-alkylene-”, “alkenylene”, “-alkenylene-”, “alkynylene”, and “-alkynylene-” are the divalent forms of the “alkyl”, “alkenyl”, and “alkynyl” groups defined above. The terms “alkylenyl”, “alkenylenyl”, and “alkynylenyl” are used when “alkylene”, “alkenylene”, and “alkynylene”, respectively, are substituted. For example, an arylalkylenyl group comprises an “alkylene” moiety to which an aryl group is attached.
  • The term “haloalkyl” is inclusive of alkyl groups that are substituted by one or more halogen atoms, including perfluorinated groups. This is also true of other groups that include the prefix “halo-”. Examples of suitable haloalkyl groups are chloromethyl, trifluoromethyl, and the like.
  • The term “aryl” as used herein includes carbocyclic aromatic rings or ring systems. Examples of aryl groups include phenyl, naphthyl, biphenyl, fluorenyl and indenyl.
  • Unless otherwise indicated, the term “heteroatom” refers to the atoms O, S, or N.
  • The term “heteroaryl” includes aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N). In some embodiments, the term “heteroaryl” includes a ring or ring system that contains 2 to 12 carbon atoms, 1 to 3 rings, 1 to 4 heteroatoms, and O, S, and/or N as the heteroatoms. Suitable heteroaryl groups include furyl, thienyl, pyridyl, quinolinyl, isoquinolinyl, indolyl, isoindolyl, triazolyl, pyrrolyl, tetrazolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, oxazolyl, thiazolyl, benzofuranyl, benzothiophenyl, carbazolyl, benzoxazolyl, pyrimidinyl, benzimidazolyl, quinoxalinyl, benzothiazolyl, naphthyridinyl, isoxazolyl, isothiazolyl, purinyl, quinazolinyl, pyrazinyl, 1-oxidopyridyl, pyridazinyl, triazinyl, tetrazinyl, oxadiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, and so on.
  • The term “heterocyclyl” includes non-aromatic rings or ring systems that contain at least one ring heteroatom (e.g., O, S, N) and includes all of the fully saturated and partially unsaturated derivatives of the above mentioned heteroaryl groups. In some embodiments, the term “heterocyclyl” includes a ring or ring system that contains 2 to 12 carbon atoms, 1 to 3 rings, 1 to 4 heteroatoms, and O, S, and N as the heteroatoms. Exemplary heterocyclyl groups include pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, piperidinyl, piperazinyl, thiazolidinyl, imidazolidinyl, isothiazolidinyl, tetrahydropyranyl, quinuclidinyl, homopiperidinyl (azepanyl), 1,4-oxazepanyl, homopiperazinyl (diazepanyl), 1,3-dioxolanyl, aziridinyl, azetidinyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, 3-azabicyclo[3.2.2]non-3-yl, and the like.
  • The term “heterocyclyl” includes bicylic and tricyclic heterocyclic ring systems. Such ring systems include fused and/or bridged rings and spiro rings. Fused rings can include, in addition to a saturated or partially saturated ring, an aromatic ring, for example, a benzene ring. Spiro rings include two rings joined by one spiro atom and three rings joined by two spiro atoms.
  • When “heterocyclyl” contains a nitrogen atom, the point of attachment of the heterocyclyl group may be the nitrogen atom.
  • The terms “arylene”, “heteroarylene”, and “heterocyclylene” are the divalent forms of the “aryl”, “heteroaryl”, and “heterocyclyl” groups defined above. The terms, “arylenyl”, “heteroarylenyl”, and “heterocyclylenyl” are used when “arylene”, “heteroarylene,” and “heterocyclylene”, respectively, are substituted. For example, an alkylarylenyl group comprises an arylene moiety to which an alkyl group is attached.
  • When a group (or substituent or variable) is present more than once in any Formula described herein, each group (or substituent or variable) is independently selected, whether explicitly stated or not. For example, for the formula —N(R8)—C(R6)—N(R8)— each R8 group is independently selected. In another example, when an R2 and an R3 group both contain an R4 group, each R4 group is independently selected. In a further example, when more than one Y group is present and each Y group contains one or more R8 groups, then each Y group is independently selected, and each R8 group is independently selected.
  • The invention is inclusive of the compounds described herein (including intermediates) in any of their pharmaceutically acceptable forms, including isomers (e.g., diastereomers and enantiomers), salts, solvates, polymorphs, prodrugs, and the like. In particular, if a compound is optically active, the invention specifically includes each of the compound's enantiomers as well as racemic mixtures of the enantiomers. It should be understood that the term “compound” includes any or all of such forms, whether explicitly stated or not (although at times, “salts” are explicitly stated).
  • The term “prodrug” means a compound that can be transformed in vivo to yield an immune response modifying compound, including any of the salt, solvated, polymorphic, or isomeric forms described above. The prodrug, itself, may be an immune response modifying compound, including any of the salt, solvated, polymorphic, or isomeric forms described above. The transformation may occur by various mechanisms, such as through a chemical (e.g., solvolysis or hydrolysis, for example, in the blood) or enzymatic biotransformation. A discussion of the use of prodrugs is provided by T. Higuchi and W. Stella, “Pro-drugs as Novel Delivery Systems,” Vol. 14 of the A. C. S. Symposium Series, and in Bioreversible Carriers in Drug Design, ed. Edward B. Roche, American Pharmaceutical Association and Pergamon Press, 1987.
  • For any of the compounds presented herein, each one of the following variables (e.g., Z, X, Y, Y′, RA, RB, R, R2, R3, Q, n, and so on) in any of its embodiments can be combined with any one or more of the other variables in any of their embodiments and associated with any one of the formulas described herein, as would be understood by one of skill in the art. Each of the resulting combinations of variables is an embodiment of the present invention.
  • For certain embodiments of Formulas I and VII, particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and RB are taken together to form a fused benzene ring wherein the benzene ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group, or substituted by one —O—R3 group and one R group. In certain of these embodiments, the fused benzene ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group.
  • For certain embodiments of Formulas I and VII, particularly embodiments of Formula I, RA and RB are taken together to form a fused pyridine ring wherein the pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group, or substituted by one —O—R3 group and one R group. In certain of these embodiments, the fused pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group.
  • For certain embodiments, the compound selected from the group consisting of Formulas III, IV, V, and VI, or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof is the compound of Formula III:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00062
  • or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
  • For certain embodiments, n is 0 in the above embodiments of Formulas II, III, IV, V, and VI.
  • For certain embodiments, R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R″ is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent.
  • For certain embodiments, R″ is a non-interfering substituent.
  • For certain embodiments, R″ is R2; wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of —R4, —X—R4, —X—Y′—R4, and —X—R5′.
  • For certain embodiments, R2 is selected from the group consisting of —R4, —X—R4, —X—Y′—R4, and —X—R5′.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments wherein R2 is present, R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, and hydroxyalkylenyl. For certain embodiments, R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, and alkoxyalkylenyl. For certain embodiments, R2 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl and alkoxyalkylenyl. For certain embodiments, R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, methyl, ethyl, propyl, butyl, ethoxymethyl, methoxymethyl, 2-methoxyethyl, hydroxymethyl, and 2-hydroxyethyl. For certain embodiments, R2 is selected from the group consisting of methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, n-butyl, ethoxymethyl, methoxymethyl, and 2-methoxyethyl.
  • For certain embodiments, particularly embodiments of Formula X, n is 0 and R2 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, and hydroxyalkylenyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R3 is selected from the group consisting of -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, -Z-R5, -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, and -Z-Het′-Y—R4.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments, R3 is Z-Y—R4 or -Z-Y—X—Y—R4. In certain of these embodiments, Y is —N(R8)-Q-,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00063
  • or —C(O)—; wherein Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, and —S(O)2—N(R8)—; R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O or ═S; R7 is C2-3 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, and C1-4 alkoxyC1-4 alkylenyl; R10 is C3-6 alkylene; and R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, halogen, and aryl; wherein aryl, heteroaryl, and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy; and wherein heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents. In certain other of these embodiments, Y is —N(R8)-Q- or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00064
  • wherein Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, and —C(R6)—N(R8)—; R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O or ═S; R7 is C2-3 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, and C1-4 alkoxyC1-4 alkylenyl; and R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, and aryl; wherein aryl and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy; and wherein heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents. In certain of these embodiments, Y is —N(R8)-Q-. In certain of these embodiments, Q is —C(O)—. In certain of these embodiments, Q is —S(O)2—. In certain of these embodiments, Q is —C(R6)—N(R8)—. In certain of these embodiments, 4 is C1-4 alkyl and R9 is hydrogen. In certain other of these embodiments, R4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by methoxy and R8 is hydrogen. In certain embodiments, Q is a bond. In certain of these embodiments, R4 is heterocyclyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl groups, and R8 is C1-4 alkyl. In certain of these embodiments, R4 is 1-methylpiperidin-4-yl and R8 is methyl. In certain embodiments, R3 is -Z-Y—R4, wherein Y is —O— and R4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, alkoxy, nitro, and haloalkyl. In certain other embodiments, R3 is -Z-Y—X—Y, —R4, wherein Y is —O—, X is phenylene, and Yc—R4 is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—O-alkyl, —S-alkyl, —NH—C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—NH2, and —S(O)2—NH2.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments not excluding this definition, R3 is -Z-R5. In certain of these embodiments, R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00065
  • wherein A is —O—, —CH2—, or —S(O)2—; R7 is C2-4 alkylene; R8 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; and a and b are each independently 1, 2, or 3. In certain embodiments, R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00066
  • wherein R7 is C2-4 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments not excluding this definition, R3 is -Z-Het or -Z-Het′-R4. In certain of these embodiments, Het and Het′ are, respectively, selected from the group consisting of the monovalent and divalent forms of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, 1,4-oxazepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, 3-azabicyclo[3.2.2]non-3-yl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For certain of these embodiments, Het and Het′ are, respectively, selected from the group consisting of the monovalent and divalent forms of pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and morpholinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For certain of these embodiments, Het is unsubstituted. For certain of these embodiments, Het′ is unsubstituted. For certain of these embodiments, Het is substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, and dialkylamino. For certain of these embodiments, R4 is heterocyclyl. For certain of these embodiments, R4 is selected from the group consisting of pyrrolidinyl and piperidinyl.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments not excluding this definition, R3 is -Z-Het′-Y—R4. In certain of these embodiments, Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent form of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2B)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, and piperazinyl. In certain of these embodiments, —Y—R4 is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—O—H, —C(O)—O-alkyl, —C(O)—NH2—, —C(O)—NH-alkyl, and —NH—C(O)-alkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R3 includes a substituted or unsubstituted thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl group or a substituted or unsubstituted thiazolo[4,5-c]naphthyridinyl group and a connecting group such that the compound is a dimer. In certain of these embodiments, R3 is -Z—Ya—X—Yb—R4 wherein Ya is —N(R8)-Q-, Yb is —O—, and R4 is thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl or thiazolo[4,5-c]naphthyridinyl. In certain of these embodiments, Q is —C(R6)—N(R8)—. In certain of these embodiments, the thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl or thiazolo[4,5-c]naphthyridinyl group is substituted by alkyl and amino.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments, Z is alkylene optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups. In certain of these embodiments, Z is selected from the group consisting of C1-6 alkylene and —CH2CH2—O—CH2CH2—.
  • For certain embodiments, including any one of the above embodiments permitted by the proviso for Formulas I through VII, more particularly for Formulas I through VI, and which do not exclude this definition, Z is a bond.
  • For certain embodiments, including any of the above embodiments, —O—R3 is at the 7-position. For other embodiments, —O—R3 is at the 8-position.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl. For certain of these embodiments, alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, and aryl. For certain other of these embodiments, alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, halogen, and aryl. For certain of these embodiments, aryl and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy. For certain of these embodiments, aryl, heteroaryl, and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy. For certain of these embodiments, heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is hydrogen or alkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is alkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is C1-4 alkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is heterocyclyl. For certain of these embodiments, R4 is selected from the group consisting of pyrrolidinyl and piperidinyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is heterocyclyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl groups. For certain of these embodiments, R4 is 1-methylpiperidin-4-yl.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by methoxy.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is heteroaryl.
  • For certain embodiments, R4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, alkoxy, nitro, and haloalkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00067
  • For certain embodiments, R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00068
  • In certain of these embodiments A is —O—, —CH2—, or —S(O)2—; R7 is C2-4 alkylene; R8 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl; and a and b are each independently 1, 2, or 3. In certain of these embodiments a and b are each 2.
  • For certain embodiments, R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00069
  • In certain of these embodiments, R7 is C2-4 alkylene. For certain embodiments, R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00070
  • In certain of these embodiments, R7 is C2-4 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00071
  • For certain embodiments, R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S.
  • For certain embodiments, R6 is ═O. For certain embodiments, R6 is ═S.
  • For certain embodiments, R7 is C2-7 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, R7 is C2-4 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, R7 is C2-3 alkylene. Preferably, in a ring of formula
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00072
  • R7 is C2-3 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, and C1-4 alkoxyC1-4 alkylenyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R8 is hydrogen or C1-4 alkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R8 is hydrogen.
  • For certain embodiments, R8 is C1-4 alkyl. For certain embodiments, R8 is methyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl.
  • For certain embodiments, R10 is C3-8 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, R10 is C4-6 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, R10 is C3-6 alkylene.
  • For certain embodiments, A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—.
  • For certain embodiments, A is —O—, —CH2—, or —S(O)2—.
  • For certain embodiments, A is —O— or —S(O)2—.
  • For certain embodiments, A is —O—.
  • For certain embodiments, A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—.
  • In certain embodiments, A′ is selected from the group consisting of —CH2—, —S(O)2—, and —O—.
  • In certain embodiments, A′ is —CH2—.
  • In certain embodiments, A′ is —O—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, and —S(O)2—N(R8)—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, and —C(R6)—N(R8)—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is —C(O)—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is —S(O)2—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is —C(R6)—N(R8)—.
  • In certain embodiments, Q is a bond.
  • In certain embodiments, V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—.
  • In certain embodiments, V is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)— and —N(R8)—C(O)—.
  • In certain embodiments, W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—.
  • In certain embodiments, W is a bond or —C(O)—.
  • In certain embodiments, W is a bond.
  • In certain embodiments, X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups. For certain embodiments, X is phenylene. For certain embodiments, X is alkylene.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —O—C(R6)—, —O—C(O)—O—, —N(R8)-Q-, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—N(OR8)—, —O—N(R8)-Q-, —O—N═C(R4)—, —C(═N—O—R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00073
  • In certain embodiments, Y is selected from the group consisting of —S(O)0-2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —O—C(R6)—, —O—C(O)—O—, —N(R8)-Q-, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, —O—C(R6)—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—N(OR9)—, —O—N(R8)-Q-, —O—N═C(R4)—, —C(═N—O—R8)—, —CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00074
  • In certain of these embodiments, Y can also be —O—. For example, Y can also be —O— when Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For these embodiments, the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy. In another example, Y can also be —O— when Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is —N(R8)-Q-,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00075
  • or —C(O)—. In certain of these embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, and —S(O)2—N(R8)—; R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O or ═S; R7 is C2-3 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, and C1-4 alkoxyC1-4 alkylenyl; R10 is C3-6 alkylene; and R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, halogen, and aryl; wherein aryl, heteroaryl, and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy; and wherein heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is —N(R8)-Q- or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00076
  • In certain of these embodiments, Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, and —C(R6)—N(R8)—; R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O or ═S; R7 is C2-3 alkylene; R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, and C1-4 alkoxyC1-4 alkylenyl; and R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl; wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, and aryl; wherein aryl and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy; and wherein heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is —N(R8)-Q-.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —C(O)—NH—, and —NH—C(O)—.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is —O—.
  • In certain embodiments, Y is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S—, —NH—C(O)—, —C(O)—NH—, and —S(O)2—NH—.
  • In certain embodiments, Y′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —O—C(R6)—, —O—C(O)—O—, —N(R9)-Q-, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00077
  • In certain embodiments, Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups.
  • In certain embodiments, Z is alkylene optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups.
  • In certain embodiments, Z is selected from the group consisting of C1-6 alkylene and —CH2CH2—O—CH2CH2—. In certain of these embodiments, Z is selected from the group consisting of C2-6 alkylene and —CH2CH2—O—CH2CH2—.
  • In certain embodiments, Z is a bond. For example, Z can be a bond when: R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00078
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00079
  • or
  • R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00080
  • wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00081
  • In certain embodiments, Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het is selected from the group consisting of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, 1,4-oxazepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, 3-azabicyclo[3.2.2]non-3-yl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For these embodiments, the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het is selected from the group consisting of pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and morpholinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For these embodiments, the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het is substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, hydroxyl, hydroxyalkyl, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, and dialkylamino.
  • In certain embodiments, Het is unsubstituted.
  • In certain embodiments, Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent forms of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, 1,1-dioxothiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, 1,4-oxazepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, 3-azabicyclo[3.2.2]non-3-yl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For these embodiments, the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent forms of tetrahydropyranyl, tetrahydrofuranyl, 1,3-dioxolanyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, morpholinyl, thiomorpholinyl, thiazolidinyl, azepanyl, diazepanyl, dihydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, octahydroisoquinolin-(1H)-yl, dihydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, octahydroquinolin-(2H)-yl, dihydro-1H-imidazolyl, and piperazinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For these embodiments, the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het′ is selected from the group consisting of the divalent forms of pyrrolidinyl, piperidinyl, and morpholinyl, each of which is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents. For these embodiments, the one or more substituents are independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo.
  • In certain embodiments, Het′ is unsubstituted (except by —R4 or —Y—R4).
  • In certain embodiments, a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7.
  • In certain embodiments, a and b are each independently 1, 2, or 3.
  • In certain embodiments, a and b are each 2.
  • In certain embodiments, n is 0 or 1.
  • In certain embodiments, n is 0.
  • For certain embodiments of the compounds of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, or VI, the —NH2 group can be replaced by an —NH-G group, as shown in the compound of Formula VII, to form prodrugs. In such embodiments, G is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)—R′, α-aminoacyl, α-aminoacyl-α-aminoacyl, —C(O)—O—R′, —C(O)—N(R′″)R′, —C(═NY1)—R′, —CH(OH)—C(O)—OY1, —CH(OC1-4 alkyl)Y0, —CH2Y2, and —CH(CH3)Y2. For these embodiments, R′ and R′″ are independently selected from the group consisting of C1-10 alkyl, C3-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, and benzyl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, nitro, cyano, carboxy, C1-6 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, aryl-C1-4 alkylenyl, heteroaryl-C1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C1-4 alkoxy, —O—C(O)—CH3, —C(O)—O—CH3, —C(O)—NH2, —O—CH2—C(O)—NH2, —NH2, and —S(O)2—NH2 with the proviso that R′″ can also be hydrogen; α-aminoacyl is an α-aminoacyl group derived from an amino acid selected from the group consisting of racemic, D-, and L-amino acids; Y1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, and benzyl; Y0 is selected from the group consisting of C1-6 alkyl, carboxy-C1-6 alkylenyl, amino-C1-4 alkylenyl, mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino-C1-4 alkylenyl, and di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino-C1-4 alkylenyl; and Y2 is selected from the group consisting of mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino, di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino, morpholin-4-yl, piperidin-1-yl, pyrrolidin-1-yl, and 4-C1-4 alkylpiperazin-1-yl.
  • For certain embodiments, the present invention provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • For certain embodiments, the present invention provides a method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising an effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI to the animal.
  • For certain embodiments, the present invention provides a method of treating a viral disease in an animal comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI to the animal.
  • For certain embodiments, the present invention provides a method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI, or a pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of any one of the above embodiments of Formulas I, II, III, IV, V, VI, VII, X, and XI to the animal.
  • Preparation of the Compounds
  • Compounds of the invention may be synthesized by synthetic routes that include processes analogous to those well known in the chemical arts, particularly in light of the description contained herein. The starting materials are generally available from commercial sources such as Aldrich Chemicals (Milwaukee, Wis., USA) or are readily prepared using methods well known to those skilled in the art (e.g. prepared by methods generally described in Louis F. Fieser and Mary Fieser, Reagents for Organic Synthesis, v. 1-19, Wiley, New York, (1967-1999 ed.); Alan R. Katritsky, Otto Meth-Cohn, Charles W. Rees, Comprehensive Organic Functional Group Transformations, v 1-6, Pergamon Press, Oxford, England, (1995); Barry M. Trost and Ian Fleming, Comprehensive Organic Synthesis, v. 1-8, Pergamon Press, Oxford, England, (1991); or Beilsteins Handbuch der organischen Chemie, 4, Aufl. Ed. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, Germany, including supplements (also available via the Beilstein online database)).
  • For illustrative purposes, the reaction schemes depicted below provide potential routes for synthesizing the compounds of the present invention as well as key intermediates. For more detailed description of the individual reaction steps, see the EXAMPLES section below. Those skilled in the art will appreciate that other synthetic routes may be used to synthesize the compounds of the invention. Although specific starting materials and reagents are depicted in the reaction schemes and discussed below, other starting materials and reagents can be easily substituted to provide a variety of derivatives and/or reaction conditions. In addition, many of the compounds prepared by the methods described below can be further modified in light of this disclosure using conventional methods well known to those skilled in the art.
  • In the preparation of compounds of the invention it may sometimes be necessary to protect a particular functionality while reacting other functional groups on an intermediate. The need for such protection will vary depending on the nature of the particular functional group and the conditions of the reaction step. Suitable amino protecting groups include acetyl, trifluoroacetyl, tert-butoxycarbonyl (Boc), benzyloxycarbonyl, and 9-fluorenylmethoxycarbonyl (Fmoc). Suitable hydroxy protecting groups include acetyl and silyl groups such as the tert-butyl dimethylsilyl group. For a general description of protecting groups and their use, see T. W. Greene and P. G. M. Wuts, Protective Groups in Organic Synthesis, John Wiley & Sons, New York, USA, 1991.
  • Conventional methods and techniques of separation and purification can be used to isolate compounds of the invention or pharmaceutically acceptable salts thereof, as well as various intermediates related thereto. Such techniques may include, for example, all types of chromatography (high performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), column chromatography using common absorbents such as silica gel, and thin layer chromatography, recrystallization, and differential (i.e., liquid-liquid) extraction techniques.
  • Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme I, where R, R2, R3, and n are as defined above. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme I, a benzyloxyaniline of Formula XV is treated with the condensation product generated from 2,2-dimethyl-1,3-dioxane-4,6-dione (Meldrum's acid) and triethyl orthoformate to provide an imine of Formula XVI. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding a solution of a benzyloxyaniline of Formula XV to a heated mixture of Meldrum's acid and triethyl orthoformate and heating the reaction at an elevated temperature such as 45° C.
  • In step (2) of Reaction Scheme I, an imine of Formula XVI undergoes thermolysis and cyclization to provide a benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVII. The reaction can be conveniently carried out in a medium such as DOWTHERM A heat transfer fluid at a temperature in the range of 200° C. to 250° C.
  • In step (3) of Reaction Scheme I, the benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVII is nitrated under conventional nitration conditions to provide a benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVIII. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding nitric acid to the benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVII in a suitable solvent such as propionic acid and heating the mixture at an elevated temperature such as 125° C.
  • In step (4) of Reaction Scheme I, a benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol of Formula XVIII is reduced to provide a 3-amino-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XIX or a salt thereof, such as the hydrochloride salt thereof. The reaction can be carried out by hydrogenation using a heterogeneous hydrogenation catalyst such as platinum on carbon. The hydrogenation is conveniently carried out in a Parr apparatus in a suitable solvent such as N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF). The reaction can be carried out at room temperature.
  • In step (5) of Reaction Scheme I, a 3-amino benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XIX is reacted with a carboxylic acid or an equivalent thereof to provide a compound of Formula XX. Suitable equivalents to carboxylic acid include acid anhydrides and acid chlorides. The selection of the carboxylic acid equivalent is determined by the desired substituent at R2. For example, the use of butyryl chloride provides a compound in which R2 is a propyl group; the use of ethoxyacetyl chloride provides a compound in which R2 is an ethoxymethyl group. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the acid chloride to a solution of a 3-aminobenzyloxyquinolin-4-ol of Formula XIX in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or acetonitrile in the presence of a tertiary amine such as triethylamine, pyridine, or 4-dimethylaminopyridine (DMAP) to afford an amide. The reaction can be carried out at or below room temperature. The amide of Formula XX can optionally be isolated and purified.
  • In step (6) of Reaction Scheme I, an amide of Formula XX is reacted with phosphorus pentasulfide to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXI. The reaction can be carried out by adding phosphorus pentasulfide to a solution or suspension of a compound of Formula XX in a suitable solvent such as pyridine and heating the resulting mixture at an elevated temperature, for example, the reflux temperature of the solvent.
  • In step (7) of Reaction Scheme I, a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXI is oxidized to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXII using a conventional oxidizing agent capable of forming N-oxides. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid to a solution of a compound of Formula XXI in a solvent such dichloromethane or chloroform. The reaction can be carried out at room temperature.
  • In step (8) of Reaction Scheme I, a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXII is aminated to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXIII. Step (8) can be carried out by the activation of an N-oxide of Formula XXII by conversion to an ester and then reacting the ester with an aminating agent. Suitable activating agents include alkyl- or arylsulfonyl chlorides such as benzenesulfonyl chloride, methanesulfonyl chloride, or p-toluenesulfonyl chloride. Suitable aminating agents include ammonia, in the form of ammonium hydroxide, for example, and ammonium salts such as ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, and ammonium phosphate. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding ammonium hydroxide followed by p-toluenesulfonyl chloride to a solution of the N-oxide of Formula XXII in a suitable solvent such as 1,2-dichloroethane at elevated temperature, for example 65° C. The reaction may also be carried out by adding ammonium hydroxide and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride to the reaction mixture from step (7) without isolating the N-oxide of Formula XXII.
  • Alternatively step (8) can be carried out by the reaction of a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXII with trichloroacetyl isocyanate followed by hydrolysis of the resulting intermediate to provide a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXIII. The reaction can be conveniently carried out in two steps by (i) adding trichloroacetyl isocyanate to a solution of the N-oxide of Formula XXII in a solvent such as dichloromethane and stirring at room temperature to provide an isolable amide intermediate. In step (ii), a solution of the intermediate in methanol is treated with a base such as sodium methoxide or ammonium hydroxide at room temperature.
  • In step (9) of Reaction Scheme I, the benzyl group of a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XXIII is cleaved to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV. The cleavage is conveniently carried out with an acid such as hydrogen bromide in a suitable solvent such as acetic acid at an elevated temperature, such as 65° C. Alternatively, the cleavage may be carried out on a Parr apparatus under hydrogenolysis conditions using a suitable heterogeneous catalyst such as palladium on carbon in a solvent such as ethanol.
  • In step (10) of Reaction Scheme I, a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV is converted to an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula II using a Williamson-type ether synthesis. The reaction is effected by treating a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV with an alkyl halide of Formula Halide-R3 in the presence of a base. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by combining the alkyl halide with a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV in a solvent such as DMF in the presence of a suitable base such as cesium carbonate. The reaction can be carried out at ambient temperature or at an elevated temperature, for example 60° C. to 85° C. Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out by treating a solution of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV in a solvent such as DMF with sodium hydride and then adding a reagent of Formula Halide-R3.
  • Numerous reagents of Formulas Halide-Z-Y—R4 and Halide-Z-Het, wherein Z, Y, R4, and Het are as defined above, are commercially available. These include, for example, bromo-substituted ketones such as 2-bromoacetophenone and 2-bromo-1-(3-thienyl)-1-ethanone, bromo-substituted esters such as ethyl bromoacetate, and bromoalkyl-substituted heterocycles such as 2-(bromomethyl)tetrahydro-2H-pyran. Other reagents of Formulas Halide-Z-Y—R4, Halide-Z-R5, Halide-Z-Y—X—Y—R4, and Halide-Z-Het, wherein Z, Y, X, R4, R5, and Het are as defined above, can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods; for example, a bromo-substituted acid halide of Formula ClC(O)-Z-Br or BrC(O)-Z-Br can be treated with a secondary amine in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane to provide a variety of bromo-substituted amides of Formula Br-Z-C(O)—N(R8)—R4,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00082
  • wherein R8, R10, A, a, and b are as defined above. The reaction can be run at a sub-ambient temperature such as −25° C.
  • Dimers of Formula II, wherein R3 is -Z-O—R4, wherein Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups, and R4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R4 above, can be prepared in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I if half an equivalent of a dialkyl halide of Formula Halide-Z-Halide is used, and the reaction can be carried out according to the conditions described above.
  • Step (10) of Reaction Scheme I can alternatively be carried out by treating a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV with an alcohol of Formula HO—R3 under Mitsunobu reaction conditions. Numerous alcohols of Formulas HO-Z-Y—R4, HO-Z-R5, and HO-Z-Het are commercially available, such as, for example, 1-(2-hydroxyethyl)pyrrolidin-2-one, 1-(3-hydroxypropyl)pyrrolidin-2-one, 3-(methylthio)propan-1-ol, and 3-hydroxytetrahydrofuran; other alcohols of Formula HO—R3 can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by out by adding triphenylphosphine and an alcohol of Formula HO—R3 to a solution of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV in a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran and then slowly adding diisopropyl azodicarboxylate or diethyl azodicarboxylate. The reaction can be carried out at or below room temperature, for example, at 0° C.
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00083
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00084
  • Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme II, where R, R2, R3, and n are as defined above. In step (1) of Reaction Scheme II, the benzyl group of a benzyloxy[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XXI is cleaved to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV. The reaction can be carried out as described in step (9) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • In step (2) of Reaction Scheme II, a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV is converted to an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XII. The reaction can be carried out using one of the methods described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • In steps (3) and (4) of Reaction Scheme II, an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XII is oxidized to afford a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XXVI, which is aminated to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula II. Steps (3) and (4) can be carried out as described in steps (7) and (8), respectively, of Reaction Scheme I.
  • Synthetic transformations can be made at R2 in compounds of Formulas XXI, XXIII, XXIV, XXV, XII, or II, shown in Reaction Scheme I or II, if, for example, the carboxylic acid or equivalent thereof used in step (5) of Reaction Scheme I contains a protected hydroxy or amino group. Some acid chlorides of this type, for example acetoxyacetyl chloride, are commercially available. Others can be prepared by known synthetic methods. A protected hydroxy or amino group thus installed at R2 can then be deprotected by a variety of methods well-known to one of skill in the art. For example, an acetate group, installed by using acetoxyacetyl chloride as the carboxylic acid equivalent in step (5) of Reaction Scheme I, is readily hydrolyzed under basic conditions to provide a hydroxy group. The resulting hydroxy group can then be oxidized to an aldehyde or carboxylic acid or converted to a leaving group such as, for example, a chloro group using thionyl chloride or a trifluoromethanesulfonate group using trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride. The resulting leaving group can then be displaced by a variety of nucleophiles. Sodium azide can be used as the nucleophile to install an azide group, which can then be reduced to an amino group using heterogeneous hydrogenation conditions. The amino group can then be converted to an amide, sulfonamide, sulfamide, or urea using one of the many methods described below in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV. A leaving group at R2, such as a chloro or trifluoromethanesulfonate group, can also be displaced with a secondary amine, a substituted phenol, or a mercaptan under the conditions described below in step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI to provide a variety of compounds. For other examples of the installation of a variety of R2 groups, see U.S. Pat. No. 6,110,929 (Gerster et al.).
  • A hydroxyalkylenyl group can also be introduced at R2 by the demethylation of a methoxyalkylenyl group, which can be installed by using a methoxy-substituted carboxylic acid equivalent, for example, methoxyacetyl chloride and 2-methoxypropionyl chloride, in step (5) of Reaction Scheme I. The demethylation can be carried out by treating a compound of Formula II wherein R2 is a methoxyalkylenyl group with boron tribromide in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane at a sub-ambient temperature such as 0° C.
  • Synthetic elaborations can also be carried out at the R3 group in compounds prepared in either Reaction Scheme I or II. For example, an R3 group in a compound of Formula XII may contain a —S— functional group, which can be oxidized to —S(O)2— in step (3) of Reaction Scheme II using an excess of the oxidizing agent. Step (4) of Reaction Scheme II may then be carried out to provide a compound of Formula II, wherein R3 contains a —S(O)2— functional group. In another example, an R3 group in a compound of Formula II may be -Z-Y—R4, wherein Y is —C(O)—. A ketone of this formula can then be converted to an oxime by adding an aqueous solution of a hydroxylamine salt of formula NH2OR8.HCl to a solution of the ketone in a suitable solvent such as methanol or ethanol and then adding a base such as sodium hydroxide and heating at an elevated temperature to provide a compound of the invention, wherein R3 is -Z-Y—R4 where Y is —C(═N—OR8)—, and R4 and R8 are as defined above. The oxime so prepared may be reduced with sodium cyanoborohydride in a mixture of ethanol or methanol in acetic acid to provide a hydroxylamine, which may be treated with one of numerous acid chlorides, sulfonyl chloride, isocyanates, carbamoyl chloride, or sulfamoyl chlorides using one of the methods described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV below to provide a compound of the invention wherein R3 is -Z-Y—R4 where Y is —CH(—N—(OR8)-Q-R4)—, and Q, R4, and R8 are as defined above.
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00085
  • Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme III where R, R2, R3, and n are as defined above. Reaction Scheme III is analogous to Reaction Scheme I, with a benzyloxypyridine of Formula XXVII used as the starting material in Reaction Scheme III instead of a benzyloxyaniline of Formula XV. Benzyloxypyridines of Formula XXVII can be prepared using conventional synthetic methods; see for example, Holladay et al., Biorg. Med. Chem. Lett., 8, pp. 2797-2802, (1998). Isomers of the compounds of Formula XXVII and Formula XXIX, wherein N is at a different position in the pyridine ring, can also be synthesized and can be used in Reaction Scheme III to prepare compounds of the invention. Steps (1) through (10) of Reaction Scheme III can be run using the same conditions described in steps (1) through (10) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00086
  • For some embodiments, compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme IV, where R, R2, R8, and n are defined as above; Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups; and R3a is -Z-N(R8)-Q-R4 or
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00087
  • with R8, R10, Q, and R4 as defined above; -Z-R5, wherein R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00088
  • with A, a, b, R7, and R8 as defined above; or -Z-[N(R8)-Q]-X—O—R4 or -Z-[N(R8)-Q]-X—[V—N(R8)]-X—O—R4, wherein X and V are as defined above, and R4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R4 above.
  • In step (1) of Reaction Scheme IV, the amine of an amino alcohol of Formula XXXVII is protected with a tert-butoxy carbonyl (Boc) group to provide a hydroxyalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXVIII. Numerous amino alcohols of Formula XXXVII are commercially available; others can be prepared using known synthetic methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by treating the amino alcohol of Formula XXXVII with di-tert-butyl dicarbonate optionally in the presence of a base such as aqueous sodium hydroxide. The reaction can be run at room temperature in a suitable solvent such as tetrahydrofuran or dichloromethane.
  • In step (2) of Reaction Scheme IV, a hydroxyalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXVIII is converted to an iodoalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXIX using conventional methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by treating the hydroxyalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXVIII with a solution of iodine, triphenylphosphine, and imidazole. The reaction can be run at room temperature in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane or solvent mixture such as diethyl ether/acetonitrile.
  • In step (3) of Reaction Scheme IV, a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV is treated with an iodoalkylcarbamate of Formula XXXIX to provide an ether-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XL. The reaction can be carried out according to the Williamson conditions described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I.
  • In steps (4) and (5) of Reaction Scheme IV, a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline of Formula XL is oxidized to a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline-5N-oxide of Formula XLI, which is aminated to provide a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLII, which is a subgenus Formulas I and II. Steps (4) and (5) of Reaction Scheme IV can be carried out as described for steps (7) and (8), respectively, of Reaction Scheme I. In step (5), the preferred conditions for amination are the activation of an N-oxide of Formula XLI by conversion to an ester and then reacting the ester with an aminating agent. Step (5) is conveniently carried out by adding ammonium hydroxide to a solution of the N-oxide of Formula XLI in a suitable solvent such as 1,2-dichloroethane and then adding p-toluenesulfonyl chloride and stirring at an elevated temperature such as 65° C.
  • In step (6) of Reaction Scheme IV, the Boc protecting group of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLII is removed to provide an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII, which is a subgenus of Formulas I and II. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding a solution of hydrochloric acid in ethanol to a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLII. The reaction can be carried out at an elevated temperature, for example, the reflux temperature of the solvent.
  • In step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV, an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII is converted to a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinyl compound of Formula IIa, a subgenus of Formulas I and II, using conventional methods. For example, an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII can react with an acid chloride of Formula R4C(O)Cl to provide a compound of Formula IIa in which R3a is -Z-N(R8)—C(O)—R4. In addition, a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII can react with sulfonyl chloride of Formula R4S(O)2Cl or a sulfonic anhydride of Formula (R4S(O)2)2O to provide a compound of Formula IIa in which R3a is -Z-N(R8)—S(O)2—R4. Numerous acid chlorides of Formula R4C(O)Cl, sulfonyl chlorides of Formula R4S(O)2Cl, and sulfonic anhydrides of Formula (R4S(O)2)2O are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the acid chloride of Formula R4C(O)Cl, sulfonyl chloride of Formula R4S(O)2Cl, or sulfonic anhydride of Formula (R4S(O)2)2O to a solution of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII in a suitable solvent such as chloroform, dichloromethane, N,N-dimethylacetamide (DMA), or 1-methyl-2-pyrrolidinone. Optionally a base such as triethylamine, pyridine, or N,N-diisopropylethylamine, or catalytic DMAP, or a combination thereof can be added. The reaction can be carried out at room temperature or initially at a sub-ambient temperature such as 0° C. and then warming to room temperature.
  • Compounds of Formula IIa where R3a is -Z-R5 and R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00089
  • can be prepared by treating an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII, wherein R8 is hydrogen, with a chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride of Formula Cl—R7S(O)2Cl or a chloroalkanoyl chloride of Formula C1—R7C(O)Cl. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the chloroalkanesulfonyl chloride or chloroalkanoyl chloride to a solution of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII in a suitable solvent such as chloroform at ambient temperature. The isolable intermediate chloroalkanesulfonamide or chloroalkanamide can then be treated with a base such as 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene or sodium hydride in a suitable solvent such as DMF to effect the cyclization.
  • Ureas of Formula IIa, where R3a is -Z-N(R8)-Q-R4, Q is —C(R6)—NH—W—, R6 is ═O, and W is a bond, can be prepared by reacting an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII with isocyanates of Formula R4N═C═O, Numerous isocyanates of Formula R4N═C═O are commercially available; others can be readily prepared using known synthetic methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding the isocyanate of Formula R4N═C═O to a solution of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane, chloroform, or DMA. Optionally a base such as triethylamine can be added. The reaction can be carried out at room temperature or initially at a sub-ambient temperature such as 0° C. and warming to room temperature. Alternatively, a compound of Formula XLIII can be treated with an isocyanate of Formula R4(CO)N═C═O, a thioisocyanate of Formula R4N═C═S, a sulfonyl isocyanate of Formula R4S(O)2N═C═O, or a carbamoyl chloride of Formula R4N—(R8)—C(O)Cl,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00090
  • to provide a compound of Formula IIa, where R3a is -Z-N(R8)-Q-R4,
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00091
  • wherein Q is —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, where R6, R8, and W are defined as above.
  • Sulfamides of Formula IIa, where R3a is -Z-N(R8)—S(O)2—N(R8)—R4 can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XLIII with sulfuryl chloride to generate a sulfamoyl chloride in situ, and then reacting the sulfamoyl chloride with an amine of Formula HN(R8)R4. Alternatively, sulfamides of Formula IIa can be prepared by reacting a compound of Formula XLIII with a sulfamoyl chloride of Formula R4(R8)N—S(O)2Cl. Many amines of Formula HN(R8)R4 and some sulfamoyl chlorides of Formula R4(R8)N—S(O)2Cl are commercially available; others can be prepared using known synthetic methods.
  • Compounds of Formula IIa, wherein R3a is -Z-N(R8)—R4 can be prepared by reductive alkylation of the amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII, wherein R8 is hydrogen. The alkylation is conveniently carried out in two parts by (i) adding an aldehyde or ketone to a solution of an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII or a salt thereof in a suitable solvent such as DMF in the presence of a base such as N,N-diisopropylethylamine. In part (ii) the reduction is carried out by adding a suitable reducing agent such as the borane-pyridine complex. Both part (i) and part (ii) can be carried out at room temperature. In compounds of Formula XLIII, wherein R8 is hydrogen, it is convenient to carry out the reductive alkylation followed by reaction with an acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, sulfonic anhydride, isocyanate, or carbamoyl chloride as described above to provide a compound of Formula IIa, wherein R3a is -Z-N(R8)-Q-R4, wherein Z, R4, R8, and Q are as defined above.
  • Dimers of Formula IIa, wherein R3a is -Z-[N(R8)-Q]-X—[V—N(R8)]-X—O—R4, wherein X and R8 are as defined above, Q is selected from the group consisting of —C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—, and R4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R4 above, can be prepared by treating an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII or a salt thereof with a diacid chloride, a disulfonyl chloride, or a diisocyanate according to the reaction conditions described above for the reactions with acid chlorides, sulfonyl chlorides, and isocyanates. Numerous diacid chlorides, disulfonyl chlorides, and diisocyanates are commercially available. These include but are not limited to aliphatic compounds such as fumaryl chloride, succinyl chloride, glutaryl chloride, sebacoyl chloride, 2,2′-oxydiacetyl chloride, 1,4-butanedisulfonyl chloride, 1,4-diisocyanatobutane, hexamethylene diisocyanate, and 1,12-diisocyanatododecane; aromatic compounds such as 1,2-benzenedisulfonyl chloride, 1,3-benzenedisulfonyl chloride, 1,4-phenylene diisocyanate, 1,5-naphthalenediisocyanate, phthaloyl chloride, and isophthaloyl chloride; cycloaliphatic compounds such as dicylcohexylmethane-4,4′-diisocyanate, trans-1,4-cyclohexane diisocyanate, and 1,3-bis(isocyanatomethyl)cyclohexane; heteroaryl compounds such as 2,6-pyrdinedicarbonyl chloride; and compounds such as 4,4′-benzoyl chloride, 4,4′-methylene-bis(benzenesulfonyl) chloride, m-xylene diisocyanate, 4,4′-diphenylmethane diisocyanate.
  • Dimers of Formula IIa, wherein R3a is -Z-[N(R8)—C(O)—N(R8)]-X—O—R4, wherein X is as defined above, and R4 is a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline optionally substituted as defined in R4 above, can be prepared by treating an amino-substituted [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine of Formula XLIII or a salt thereof with carbonyldiimidazole in a suitable solvent such as DMF at an elevated temperature such as 75° C.
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00092
  • Compounds of the invention can be prepared according to Reaction Scheme V, where R, R2, R10, and n are as defined above; Za is selected from the group consisting of a bond, alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups; R3b is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00093
  • wherein R4, R6, R10, A, Q, a, and b are as defined above. Steps (1) through (7) of Reaction Scheme V can be run as described in steps (1) through (7) of Reaction Scheme IV to provide compounds of Formula IIb, a subgenus of Formulas I and II.
  • Alternatively, a compound of Formula XLV can react with a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV under the Mitsunobu reaction conditions described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I. For example, combining a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV, triphenylphosphine, and tert-butyl 4-hydroxy-1-piperidinecarboxylate in THF at 5° C. or room temperature and slowly adding diisopropyl azodicarboxylate provides a compound of Formula XLVII wherein Za is a bond and R10 is pentylene.
  • The oxidation in step (4) of Reaction Scheme V can be carried out according to the reaction conditions described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme I or by heating a solution of a compound of Formula XLVII in a suitable solvent such as ethyl acetate with peracetic acid at a temperature such as 50° C. and then adding sodium metabisulfate.
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00094
  • Compounds of the invention can also be prepared according to Reaction Scheme VI, wherein R, R2, and n are as defined above; Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups; and R3c is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, wherein Het or Het′ is attached to Z at a nitrogen atom.
  • In step (1) of Reaction Scheme VI, a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXIV is treated with a dihalide of Formula I-Z-Cl or Br-Z-Cl using the Williamson conditions described in step (10) of Reaction Scheme I to provide a chloro-substituted compound of Formula X.
  • In step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI, a chloro-substituted compound of Formula X is treated with a cyclic secondary amine to provide a compound of Formula IIc, a subgenus of Formulas I and II. Many cyclic secondary amines are commercially available, such as unsubstituted or substituted pyrrolidines, piperidines, morpholines, and piperazines; others can be prepared using conventional methods. The reaction can be conveniently carried out by adding a cyclic secondary amine to a compound of Formula X in a suitable solvent such as DMF. The reaction can be conveniently carried out in the presence of a base such as potassium carbonate at an elevated temperature such as 65° C.
  • Compounds of Formula IIc are also prepared from [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinols of Formula XXV, shown in Reaction Scheme II. A [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol of Formula XXV is first treated with a dihalide of Formula I-Z-Cl or Br-Z-Cl according to step (1) of Reaction Scheme V. The product is then oxidized and aminated according to the methods described in steps (7) and (8) of Reaction Scheme I to provide a compound of Formula X, which is then treated with a cyclic secondary amine as described in step (2) of Reaction Scheme VI to provide a compound of Formula IIc.
  • A compound of Formula X is also a useful starting material to provide a number of other compounds of the invention. For example, a compound of Formula X can be treated with a non-cyclic secondary amine or a mercaptan under the conditions described in step (2) above to provide a compound in which R3c is -Z-Y—R4, wherein R4 is as defined above and Y is —N(R8)-Q- or —S—, wherein Q is a bond and R8 is as defined above. In another example, a compound of Formula X can be treated under the same conditions with a substituted phenol to provide a compound wherein R3c is -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, in which the Y bonded to Z is —O—, X is phenylene, and R4 and the Y bonded to R4 are as defined above or a compound wherein R3c is -Z-Y—R4, in which Y is —O—, and R4 is phenyl that is optionally substituted. In yet another example, a compound of Formula X can be treated with N-hydroxyphthalimide in the presence of a base, such as triethylamine, in a suitable solvent such as DMF at ambient temperature. The phthalimide group can then be removed from the resulting N-phthalimide-protected hydroxylamine by treatment with hydrazine at ambient temperature in a suitable solvent such as ethanol. The resulting hydroxylamine can then be treated with one of numerous commercially available aldehydes or ketones in a suitable solvent such as methanol to provide a compound of Formula IIc wherein R3c is -Z-Y—R4 or -Z-R5, where Y is —O—N═C(R4)—, R5 is
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00095
  • and R4, a, b, and A′ are as defined above. Alternatively, the hydroxylamine prepared after the hydrazine deprotection may be treated with one of numerous acid chlorides, sulfonyl chloride, isocyanates, carbamoyl chloride, or sulfamoyl chlorides using one of the methods described in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV to provide a compound Formula IIc wherein R3c is -Z-Y—R4 where Y is —O—NH-Q-, and Q and R4 are as defined above.
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00096
  • Compounds of the invention can also be prepared using variations of the synthetic routes shown in Reaction Schemes I through VI that would be apparent to one of skill in the art. For example, the synthetic route shown in Reaction Scheme IV for the preparation of quinolines having a R3a substituent can be used to prepare [1,5]naphthyridines having a R3a substituent by using a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c][1,5]naphthyridinol in lieu of the [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol. Similarly, the synthetic routes shown in Reaction Schemes V and VII can be carried out using a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c][1,5]naphthyridinol instead of a [1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolinol as a starting material. Compounds of the invention can also be prepared using the synthetic routes described in the EXAMPLES below.
  • Prodrugs can be prepared in a variety of ways. For example, a compound wherein R3 or R2 is —X—OH (e.g. hydroxyalkyl) can be converted into a prodrug wherein R3 or R2 is, for example, —X—O—C(R6)—R4, —X—O—C(R6)—O—R4, or —X—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—R4, wherein X, R4, R6, and R8 are as defined above, using methods known to one skilled in the art. In addition, a compound wherein R is hydroxy may also be converted to an ester, an ether, a carbonate, or a carbamate. For any of these compounds containing an alcohol functional group, a prodrug can be formed by the replacement of the hydrogen atom of the alcohol group with a group such as C1-6 alkanoyloxymethyl, 1-(C1-6 alkanoyloxy)ethyl, 1-methyl-1-(C1-6 alkanoyloxy)ethyl, C1-6 alkoxycarbonyloxymethyl, N—(C1-6 alkoxycarbonyl)aminomethyl, succinoyl, C1-6 alkanoyl, α-aminoC1-4 alkanoyl, arylacyl, —P(O)(OH)2, —P(O)(O—C1-6 alkyl)2, C1-6 alkoxycarbonyl, C1-6 alkylcarbamoyl, and α-aminoacyl or α-aminoacyl-α-aminoacyl, where each α-aminoacyl group is independently selected from racemic, D-, and L-amino acids. For compounds containing an alcohol functional group, particularly useful prodrugs are esters made from carboxylic acids containing one to six carbon atoms, unsubstituted or substituted benzoic acid esters, or esters made from amino acids. The reaction conditions described above in step (7) of Reaction Scheme IV can be used.
  • Prodrugs can also be made from a compound containing an amino group by conversion of the amino group to a functional group such as an amide, carbamate, urea, amidine, or another hydrolyzable group using conventional methods. A prodrug of this type can be made by the replacement of a hydrogen atom in an amino group, particularly the amino group at the 4-position, with a group such as —C(O)—R′, α-aminoacyl, α-aminoacyl-α-aminoacyl, —C(O)—O—R′, —C(O)—N(R′″)—R′, —C(═NY1)—R′, —CH(OH)—C(O)—OY1, —CH(OC1-4 alkyl)Y0, —CH2Y2, or —CH(CH3)Y2; wherein R′ and R′″ are each independently C1-10 alkyl, C3-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, or benzyl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, nitro, cyano, carboxy, C1-6 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, arylC1-4 alkylenyl, heteroarylC1-4 alkylenyl, haloC1-4 alkyl, haloC1-4 alkoxy, —O—C(O)—CH3, —C(O)—O—CH3, —C(O)—NH2, —O—CH2—C(O)—NH2, —NH2, and —S(O)2—NH2, with the proviso that R′″ can also be hydrogen; each α-aminoacyl group is independently selected from racemic, D-, and L-amino acids; Y1 is hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, or benzyl; Y0 is C1-6 alkyl, carboxyC1-6 alkylenyl, aminoC1-4 alkylenyl, mono-N—C1-6 alkylaminoC1-4 alkylenyl, or di-N,N—C1-6 alkylaminoC1-4 alkylenyl; and Y2 is mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino, di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino, morpholin-4-yl, piperidin-1-yl, pyrrolidin-1-yl, or 4-C1-4 alkylpiperazin-1-yl. For compounds containing an amine functional group, particularly useful prodrugs are amides derived from carboxylic acids containing one to ten carbon atoms, amides derived from racemic, D-, or L-amino acids, and carbamates containing one to ten carbon atoms. The reaction can be carried out, for example, by combining a compound of Formula I, II, III, IV, V, or VI with a chloroformate or acid chloride, such as ethyl chloroformate or acetyl chloride, in the presence of a base such as triethylamine in a suitable solvent such as dichloromethane at room temperature.
  • Pharmaceutical Compositions and Biological Activity
  • Pharmaceutical compositions of the invention contain a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt described above in combination with a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
  • The terms “a therapeutically effective amount” and “effective amount” mean an amount of the compound or salt sufficient to induce a therapeutic or prophylactic effect, such as cytokine induction, immunomodulation, antitumor activity, and/or antiviral activity. The exact amount of compound or salt used in a pharmaceutical composition of the invention will vary according to factors known to those of skill in the art, such as the physical and chemical nature of the compound or salt, the nature of the carrier, and the intended dosing regimen.
  • In some embodiments, the compositions of the invention will contain sufficient active ingredient or prodrug to provide a dose of about 100 nanograms per kilogram (ng/kg) to about 50 milligrams per kilogram (mg/kg), preferably about 10 micrograms per kilogram (μg/kg) to about 5 mg/kg, of the compound or salt to the subject.
  • In other embodiments, the compositions of the invention will contain sufficient active ingredient or prodrug to provide a dose of, for example, from about 0.01 mg/m2 to about 5.0 mg/m2, computed according to the Dubois method, in which the body surface area of a subject (m2) is computed using the subject's body weight: m2=(wt kg0.425×height cm0.725)×0.007184, although in some embodiments the methods may be performed by administering a compound or salt or composition in a dose outside this range. In some of these embodiments, the method includes administering sufficient compound to provide a dose of from about 0.1 mg/m2 to about 2.0 mg/m2 to the subject, for example, a dose of from about 0.4 mg/m2 to about 1.2 mg/m2.
  • A variety of dosage forms may be used, such as tablets, lozenges, capsules, parenteral formulations, syrups, creams, ointments, aerosol formulations, transdermal patches, transmucosal patches and the like. These dosage forms can be prepared with conventional pharmaceutically acceptable carriers and additives using conventional methods, which generally include the step of bringing the active ingredient into association with the carrier.
  • The compounds or salts of the invention can be administered as the single therapeutic agent in the treatment regimen, or the compounds or salts described herein may be administered in combination with one another or with other active agents, including additional immune response modifiers, antivirals, antibiotics, antibodies, proteins, peptides, oligonucleotides, etc.
  • Compounds or salts of the invention have been shown to induce the production of certain cytokines in experiments performed according to the tests set forth below. These results indicate that the compounds or salts are useful for modulating the immune response in a number of different ways, rendering them useful in the treatment of a variety of disorders.
  • Cytokines whose production may be induced by the administration of compounds or salts of the invention generally include interferon-α (IFN-α) and tumor necrosis factor-α (TNF-α) as well as certain interleukins (IL). Cytokines whose biosynthesis may be induced by compounds or salts of the invention include IFN-α, TNF-α, IL-1, IL-6, IL-10 and IL-12, and a variety of other cytokines. Among other effects, these and other cytokines can inhibit virus production and tumor cell growth, making the compounds or salts useful in the treatment of viral diseases and neoplastic diseases. Accordingly, the invention provides a method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal. The animal to which the compound or salt is administered for induction of cytokine biosynthesis may have a disease as described infra, for example a viral disease or a neoplastic disease, and administration of the compound or salt may provide therapeutic treatment. Alternatively, the compound or salt may be administered to the animal prior to the animal acquiring the disease so that administration of the compound or salt may provide a prophylactic treatment.
  • In addition to the ability to induce the production of cytokines, compounds or salts described herein can affect other aspects of the innate immune response. For example, natural killer cell activity may be stimulated, an effect that may be due to cytokine induction. The compounds or salts may also activate macrophages, which in turn stimulate secretion of nitric oxide and the production of additional cytokines. Further, the compounds or salts may cause proliferation and differentiation of B-lymphocytes.
  • Compounds or salts described herein can also have an effect on the acquired immune response. For example, the production of the T helper type 1 (TH1) cytokine IFN-γ may be induced indirectly and the production of the T helper type 2 (TH2) cytokines IL-4, IL-5 and IL-13 may be inhibited upon administration of the compounds or salts.
  • Whether for prophylaxis or therapeutic treatment of a disease, and whether for effecting innate or acquired immunity, the compound or salt or composition may be administered alone or in combination with one or more active components as in, for example, a vaccine adjuvant. When administered with other components, the compound or salt or composition and other component or components may be administered separately; together but independently such as in a solution; or together and associated with one another such as (a) covalently linked or (b) non-covalently associated, e.g., in a colloidal suspension.
  • Conditions for which compounds or salts or compositions identified herein may be used as treatments include, but are not limited to:
  • (a) viral diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by an adenovirus, a herpesvirus (e.g., HSV-I, HSV-II, CMV, or VZV), a poxvirus (e.g., an orthopoxvirus such as variola or vaccinia, or molluscum contagiosum), a picornavirus (e.g., rhinovirus or enterovirus), an orthomyxovirus (e.g., influenzavirus), a paramyxovirus (e.g., parainfluenzavirus, mumps virus, measles virus, and respiratory syncytial virus (RSV)), a coronavirus (e.g., SARS), a papovavirus (e.g., papillomaviruses, such as those that cause genital warts, common warts, or plantar warts), a hepadnavirus (e.g., hepatitis B virus), a flavivirus (e.g., hepatitis C virus or Dengue virus), or a retrovirus (e.g., a lentivirus such as HIV);
  • (b) bacterial diseases such as, for example, diseases resulting from infection by bacteria of, for example, the genus Escherichia, Enterobacter, Salmonella, Staphylococcus, Shigella, Listeria, Aerobacter, Helicobacter, Klebsiella, Proteus, Pseudomonas, Streptococcus, Chlamydia, Mycoplasma, Pneumococcus, Neisseria, Clostridium, Bacillus, Corynebacterium, Mycobacterium, Campylobacter, Vibrio, Serratia, Providencia, Chromobacterium, Brucella, Yersinia, Haemophilus, or Bordetella;
  • (c) other infectious diseases, such as chlamydia, fungal diseases including but not limited to candidiasis, aspergillosis, histoplasmosis, cryptococcal meningitis, or parasitic diseases including but not limited to malaria, pneumocystis carnii pneumonia, leishmaniasis, cryptosporidiosis, toxoplasmosis, and trypanosome infection;
  • (d) neoplastic diseases, such as intraepithelial neoplasias, cervical dysplasia, actinic keratosis, basal cell carcinoma, squamous cell carcinoma, renal cell carcinoma, Kaposi's sarcoma, melanoma, leukemias including but not limited to acute myeloid leukemia, acute lymphocytic leukemia, chronic myeloid leukemia, chronic lymphocytic leukemia, multiple myeloma, Hodgkin's lymphoma, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, cutaneous T-cell lymphoma, B-cell lymphoma, and hairy cell leukemia, and other cancers;
  • (e) TH2-mediated, atopic diseases, such as atopic dermatitis or eczema, eosinophilia, asthma, allergy, allergic rhinitis, and Ommen's syndrome;
  • (f) certain autoimmune diseases such as systemic lupus erythematosus, essential thrombocythaemia, multiple sclerosis, discoid lupus, alopecia greata; and
  • (g) diseases associated with wound repair such as, for example, inhibition of keloid formation and other types of scarring (e.g., enhancing wound healing, including chronic wounds).
  • Additionally, a compound or salt identified herein may be useful as a vaccine adjuvant for use in conjunction with any material that raises either humoral and/or cell mediated immune response, such as, for example, live viral, bacterial, or parasitic immunogens; inactivated viral, tumor-derived, protozoal, organism-derived, fungal, or bacterial immunogens; toxoids; toxins; self-antigens; polysaccharides; proteins; glycoproteins; peptides; cellular vaccines; DNA vaccines; autologous vaccines; recombinant proteins; and the like, for use in connection with, for example, BCG, cholera, plague, typhoid, hepatitis A, hepatitis B, hepatitis C, influenza A, influenza B, parainfluenza, polio, rabies, measles, mumps, rubella, yellow fever, tetanus, diphtheria, hemophilus influenza b, tuberculosis, meningococcal and pneumococcal vaccines, adenovirus, HIV, chicken pox, cytomegalovirus, dengue, feline leukemia, fowl plague, HSV-1 and HSV-2, hog cholera, Japanese encephalitis, respiratory syncytial virus, rotavirus, papilloma virus, yellow fever, and Alzheimer's Disease.
  • Compounds or salts identified herein may be particularly helpful in individuals having compromised immune function. For example, compounds or salts may be used for treating the opportunistic infections and tumors that occur after suppression of cell mediated immunity in, for example, transplant patients, cancer patients and HIV patients.
  • Thus, one or more of the above diseases or types of diseases, for example, a viral disease or a neoplastic disease may be treated in an animal in need thereof (having the disease) by administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal.
  • An animal may also be vaccinated by administering an effective amount of a compound or salt described herein, as a vaccine adjuvant. In one embodiment, there is provided a method of vaccinating an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt described herein to the animal as a vaccine adjuvant.
  • An amount of a compound or salt effective to induce cytokine biosynthesis is an amount sufficient to cause one or more cell types, such as monocytes, macrophages, dendritic cells and B-cells to produce an amount of one or more cytokines such as, for example, IFN-α, TNF-α, IL-1, IL-6, IL-10 and IL-12 that is increased (induced) over a background level of such cytokines. The precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 μg/kg to about 5 mg/kg. In other embodiments, the amount is expected to be a dose of, for example, from about 0.01 mg/m2 to about 5.0 mg/m2, (computed according to the Dubois method as described above) although in some embodiments the induction or inhibition of cytokine biosynthesis may be performed by administering a compound or salt in a dose outside this range. In some of these embodiments, the method includes administering sufficient compound or salt or composition to provide a dose of from about 0.1 mg/m2 to about 2.0 mg/m2 to the subject, for example, a dose of from about 0.4 mg/m2 to about 1.2 mg/m2.
  • The invention also provides a method of treating a viral infection in an animal and a method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of the invention to the animal. An amount effective to treat or inhibit a viral infection is an amount that will cause a reduction in one or more of the manifestations of viral infection, such as viral lesions, viral load, rate of virus production, and mortality as compared to untreated control animals. The precise amount that is effective for such treatment will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 μg/kg to about 5 mg/kg. An amount of a compound or salt effective to treat a neoplastic condition is an amount that will cause a reduction in tumor size or in the number of tumor foci. Again, the precise amount will vary according to factors known in the art but is expected to be a dose of about 100 ng/kg to about 50 mg/kg, preferably about 10 μg/kg to about 5 mg/kg. In other embodiments, the amount is expected to be a dose of, for example, from about 0.01 mg/m2 to about 5.0 mg/m2, (computed according to the Dubois method as described above) although in some embodiments either of these methods may be performed by administering a compound or salt in a dose outside this range. In some of these embodiments, the method includes administering sufficient compound or salt to provide a dose of from about 0.1 mg/m2 to about 2.0 mg/m2 to the subject, for example, a dose of from about 0.4 mg/m2 to about 1.2 mg/m2.
  • In addition to the formulations and uses described specifically herein, other formulations, uses, and administration devices suitable for compounds of the present invention are described in, for example, International Publication Nos. WO 03/077944 and WO 02/036592, U.S. Pat. No. 6,245,776, and U.S. Publication Nos. 2003/0139364, 2003/185835, 2004/0258698, 2004/0265351, 2004/076633, and 2005/0009858.
  • Objects and advantages of this invention are further illustrated by the following examples, but the particular materials and amounts thereof recited in these examples, as well as other conditions and details, should not be construed to unduly limit this invention.
  • EXAMPLES Example 1 7-(2-Morpholin-4-ylethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00097
  • Part A
  • A mixture of triethyl orthoformate (92 milliliters (mL), 0.55 moles (mol)) and 2,2-dimethyl-[1,3]-dioxane-4,6-dione (75.3 grams (g), 0.522 mol) (Meldrum's acid) was heated at 55° C. for 90 minutes and then cooled to 45° C. A solution of 3-benzyloxyaniline (100.2 g, 0.5029 mol) in methanol (200 mL) was slowly added to the reaction over a period 45 minutes while maintaining the reaction temperature below 50° C. The reaction was then heated at 45° C. for one hour, allowed to cool to room temperature, and stirred overnight. The reaction mixture was cooled to 1° C., and the product was isolated by filtration and washed with cold ethanol (approximately 400 mL) until the filtrate was colorless. 5-{[(3-Benzyloxy)phenylimino]methyl}-2,2-dimethyl-[1,3]-dioxane-4,6-dione (170.65 g) was isolated as a tan, powdery solid. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 11.21 (d, J=14.2 Hz, 1H), 8.61 (d, J=14.2 Hz, 1H), 7.49-7.30 (m, 7H), 7.12 (dd, J=8.1, 1.96 Hz, 1H), 6.91 (dd, J=8.4, 2.1 Hz, 1H), 5.16 (s, 2H), 1.68 (s, 6H).
  • Part B
  • A mixture of 5-{[(3-benzyloxy)phenylimino]methyl}-2,2-dimethyl-[1,3]-dioxane-4,6-dione (170.65 g, 0.483 mol) and DOWTHERM A (800 mL) heat transfer fluid was heated to 100° C. and then slowly added to a flask containing DOWTHERM A (1.3 liters (L), heated at 210° C.) heat transfer fluid over a period of 40 minutes. During the addition, the reaction temperature was not allowed to fall below 207° C. Following the addition, the reaction was stirred at 210° C. for one hour, and then allowed to cool to ambient temperature. A precipitate formed, which was isolated by filtration, washed sequentially with diethyl ether (1.7 L) and acetone (0.5 L), and dried in an oven to provide 76.5 g of 7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol as a tan powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 11.53 (s, 1H), 7.99 (dd, J=2.4, 7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.79 (d, J=7.4 Hz, 1H), 7.50-7.32 (m, 5H), 7.00 (s, 1H), 6.98 (dd, J=2.5, 7.4 Hz, 1H), 5.93 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H), 5.20 (s, 2H).
  • Part C
  • A mixture of 7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol (71.47 g, 0.2844 mol) and propionic acid (700 mL) was heated to 125° C. with vigorous stirring. Nitric acid (23.11 mL of 16 molar (M)) was slowly added over a period of 30 minutes while maintaining the reaction temperature between 121° C. and 125° C. After the addition, the reaction was stirred at 125° C. for one hour then allowed to cool to room temperature. The resulting solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, and dried in an oven for 1.5 days to provide 69.13 g of 7-benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol as a grayish powder. 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 12.77 (s, 1H), 9.12 (s, 1H), 8.17 (dd, J=3.3, 6.3 Hz, 1H), 7.51-7.33 (m, 5H), 7.21-7.17 (m, 2H), 5.25 (s, 2H). Material from a separate run was used in the next step.
  • Part D
  • A mixture of 7-benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-4-ol (10.67 g, 36.0 millimoles (mmol)) and 5% platinum on carbon (1.05 g) in N,N-dimethylformamide (DMF) (110 mL) was hydrogenated on a Parr apparatus. The mixture was filtered through CELITE filter agent. The CELITE filter agent was rinsed with DMF (20 mL). The filtrate was cooled in an ice bath and acidified with hydrogen chloride gas, resulting in the formation of a reddish-brown solid. The solid was isolated by filtration, washed with acetone, and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 8.17 g of 3-amino-7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol hydrochloride as a tan solid.
  • Part E
  • To a solution of the crude 3-amino-7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol hydrochloride (8.03 g, 26.5 mmol) prepared in Part D and triethylamine (7.40 mL, 53 mmol) in dichloromethane at 0° C. was added butyryl chloride (2.75 mL, 26.5 mmol) dropwise. The solution was stirred at 0° C. for ten minutes, and then the cooling bath was removed. A solid formed that was isolated by filtration and washed with a small amount of dichloromethane. The solid was triturated with water (75 mL) and was isolated by filtration. The solid was rinsed sequentially with water and diethyl ether and dried at 60° C. in a vacuum oven to provide 8.03 g of N-(7-benzyloxy-4-hydroxyquinolin-3-yl)butyramide, containing a small amount of triethylamine hydrochloride as determined by proton nuclear magnetic resonance spectroscopy (1H NMR) analysis.
  • Part F
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, a mixture of the N-(7-benzyloxy-4-hydroxyquinolin-3-yl)butyramide prepared in Part E (2.97 g, 8.83 mmol), phosphorus pentasulfide (1.96 g, 4.41 mmol), and pyridine was heated to reflux. The resulting solution was cooled and the excess phosphorus pentasulfide was quenched slowly with 10% aqueous sodium carbonate (10 mL). The reaction mixture was partitioned between water (40 mL) and dichloromethane (100 mL). The organic layer was washed with 0.1 M aqueous hydrochloric acid (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated under reduced pressure to yield a brownish-yellow solid. The solid was recrystallized from heptane (40 mL, hot filtration). The crystals were isolated by filtration and washed with cold heptane to provide 1.74 g of 7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a light yellow solid.
  • Part G
  • To a solution of 7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (4.89 g, 14.6 mmol) in dichloromethane (75 mL) at room temperature was added 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid (mCPBA) (5.82 g of 65% purity, 21.93 mmol) in portions. After one hour of stirring, the mixture was washed with 10% aqueous sodium carbonate (2×50 mL). The combined washings were extracted with dichloromethane (50 mL), and the combined organic fractions were washed with water (75 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, concentrated under reduced pressure, and dried under high vacuum to yield 4.93 g of 7-benzyloxy-5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a light yellow solid.
  • Part H
  • To a light orange solution of 7-benzyloxy-5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (4.93 g, 14.1 mmol) in dichloromethane (100 mL) at 0° C. was added trichloroacetyl isocyanate (2.00 mL, 16.9 mmol). The solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and was stirred for 20 hours. The solution was concentrated under reduced pressure, and the residue, N-(7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-yl)-2,2,2-trichloroacetamide, was used without further manipulation in the next step.
  • Part I
  • To a stirred mixture of N-(7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-yl)-2,2,2-trichloroacetamide (6.96 g, 14.9 mmol) in methanol (100 mL) at room temperature was added sodium methoxide (11.3 mL of a 25 weight % solution in methanol, 52.1 mmol). After a few minutes a solution formed from which a solid precipitated. The reaction mixture was concentrated under reduced pressure and further dried under vacuum. The resulting solid was suspended in a minimal amount of methanol (50 mL) and was isolated by filtration. The solid was washed with methanol to provide 3.93 g of 7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a light yellow solid, mp 175-178° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.67 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 7.49-7.29 (m, 5H), 7.10 (d, J=2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.96 (dd, J=8.7, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.84 (s, 2H), 5.20 (s, 2H), 3.09 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.2 Hz, 2H), 0.99 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.1, 158.9, 152.4, 146.5, 139.4, 137.0, 136.0, 128.4, 127.8, 127.6, 125.7, 113.3, 113.2, 107.8, 69.3, 35.1, 22.8, 13.5; MS (APCI) m/z 350.0 (M+H+).
  • Part J
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, a solution of hydrogen bromide in acetic acid (50 mL of 30% weight/weight (w/w)) was added to 7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (3.55 g, 10.2 mmol), and the reaction was heated at 65° C. for 30 minutes and then cooled to approximately 0° C. Aqueous sodium hydroxide (50% w/w) was added slowly to adjust the reaction mixture to pH 7. A light yellow solid formed, which was isolated by filtration and air-dried to provide 4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol acetic acid salt.
  • Part K
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, cesium carbonate (6.29 g, 19.3 mmol) was added to a suspension of the material from Part J (3.86 mmol) in DMF (20 mL), and the reaction mixture was heated at 75° C. for 30 minutes. 4-(2-Chloroethyl)morpholine hydrochloride (0.90 g, 4.8 mmol) was then added, and the mixture was stirred at 75° C. overnight. The solvent was then removed under reduced pressure at 65° C. The resulting solid was partitioned between dichloromethane (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting dark brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (an automated, modular high-performance flash purification product available from Biotage, Inc, Charlottesville, Va., USA) (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 30% 80:18:2 chloroform/methanol/concentrated ammonium hydroxide (CMA) in chloroform) to provide 0.48 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum. The solid was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (30 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 0.32 g of 7-(2-morpholin-4-ylethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as light yellow needles, mp 122-125° C. 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.65 (d, J=8.5, 1H), 7.03 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.5, 2.5, 1H), 6.79 (s, 2H), 4.17 (t, J=5.6, 2H), 3.58 (t, J=4.8, 4H), 3.11 (t, J=7.6, 2H), 2.72 (t, J=5.6, 2H), 2.48 (m, 4H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.0, 152.3, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.7, 113.1, 113.0, 107.3, 66.1, 65.4, 57.0, 53.6, 35.1, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C19H24N4O2S: C, 61.27; H, 6.49; N, 15.04. Found: C, 61.24; H, 6.54; N, 14.94.
  • Example 2 2-Propyl-7-(2-pyrrolidin-1-ylethoxy)[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00098
  • The method described in Part K of Example 1 was used to treat the material from Part J of Example 1 (5.40 mmol) in DMF (25 mL) with cesium carbonate (11.00 g, 33.75 mmol) and 1-(2-chloroethyl)pyrrolidine hydrochloride (1.15 g, 6.75 mmol) with the modification that the reaction was carried out at 70° C. instead of 75° C. The purification methods described in Part K of Example 1 were used to provide 0.33 g of 2-propyl-7-(2-pyrrolidin-1-ylethoxy)[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as light yellow needles, mp 124-127° C. 1H NMR (500 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.59 (d, J=8.8, 1H), 7.17 (d, J=2.2, 1H), 6.98 (dd, J=8.9, 2.5, 11H), 5.51 (s, 2H), 4.22 (t, J=5.7, 2H), 3.09 (t, J=7.6, 2H) 2.95 (t, J=6.0, 2H), 2.63 (m, 4H), 1.93 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.80 (m, 4H), 1.07 (t, J=7.2, 3H); 13C NMR (125 Hz, CDCl3) δ 169.7, 159.8, 151.8, 146.2, 140.7, 136.4, 125.6, 115.0, 114.3, 107.5, 67.2, 55.1, 54.7, 36.0, 23.5, 23.2, 13.7;
  • Anal. calcd for C19H24N4OS: C, 64.02; H, 6.79; N, 15.72. Found: C, 63.85; H, 6.65; N, 15.64.
  • Example 3 7-(2-Piperidin-1-ylethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00099
  • The method described in Part K of Example 1 were used to treat the material from Part J of Example 1 (5.67 mmol) in DMF (25 mL) with cesium carbonate (9.24 g, 28.4 mmol) and 1-(2-chloroethyl)piperidine hydrochloride (1.30 g, 7.09 mmol) with the modification that the reaction was carried out at 70° C. instead of 75° C. The purification methods described in Part K of Example 1 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 35% CMA in chloroform, to provide 0.41 g of 7-(2-piperidin-1-ylethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as light yellow needles, mp 141-143° C. 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.65 (d, J=8.9, 1H), 7.03 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.89 (dd, J=8.9, 2.2, 1H), 6.79 (s, 2H), 4.14 (t, J=6.0, 2H), 3.10 (t, J=7.5, 2H), 2.67 (t, J=6.0, 2H), 2.43 (m, 4H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.49 (quin, J=4.6, 4H), 1.36 (m 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.6, 3H); 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.1, 152.4, 146.5, 139.4, 136.0, 125.7, 113.1, 113.0, 107.3, 65.7, 57.3, 54.4, 35.1, 25.6, 23.9, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C20H26N4OS: C, 64.83; H, 7.07; N, 15.12. Found: C, 64.52; H, 7.37; N, 14.80.
  • Example 4 tert-Butyl 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00100
  • Part A
  • A solution of 3-amino-1-propanol (14.88 g, 0.1981 mol) in dichloromethane (130 mL) was cooled to approximately 0° C., and a solution of di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (46.70 g, 0.2140 mol) in dichloromethane (100 mL) was added dropwise over a period of 45 minutes. Upon the completion of the addition, the resulting solution was washed sequentially with aqueous sodium carbonate (2×100 mL of 2 M), acetic acid (2×50 mL of 5% w/w), and brine (75 mL); dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 39.02 g of tert-butyl 3-hydroxypropylcarbamate as a colorless oil containing some tert-butanol.
  • Part B
  • A mixture of tert-butyl 3-hydroxypropylcarbamate (19.36 g, 110.5 mmol), triphenylphosphine (34.76 g, 132.6 mmol), imidazole (10.53 g, 154.7 mmol), diethyl ether (500 mL), and acetonitrile (150 mL) was cooled to approximately 0° C., and iodine (36.45 g, 143.6 mmol) was added in one portion. The reaction mixture was allowed to warm to room temperature slowly and stirred overnight. A precipitate formed, which was removed by filtration and washed with a small amount of diethyl ether. The filtrate was washed sequentially with water (2×500 mL), saturated aqueous sodium thiosulfate (2×250 mL), water (250 mL), and brine (250 mL); dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide a mixture of a yellow oil and a white solid. The mixture was diluted with heptane (50 mL) and filtered to remove the solid, which was washed with heptane (50 mL). The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide an oil that was diluted with heptane (50 mL) and filtered to remove a solid, which was washed with heptane (50 mL). The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 22.60 g of tert-butyl 3-iodopropylcarbamate as a yellow oil containing about 9 mol % triphenylphosphine oxide as determined by 1H NMR.
  • Part C
  • To 7-benzyloxy-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (prepared as described in Part F of Example 1, 4.52 g, 13.5 mmol) was added hydrogen bromide (40 mL of a 45 wt. % solution in acetic acid). The resulting solution was heated at 65° C. for 1.5 hours and then cooled in an ice bath. Aqueous sodium hydroxide (50% w/w solution) was added slowly to adjust the solution to pH 7, and a light yellow solid formed. The solid was isolated by filtration, dried, and then suspended in boiling ethanol (25 mL) for 5 minutes. The mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature, and a tan solid was isolated by filtration. The solid was washed with cold ethanol and dried in a vacuum oven to yield 2.69 g of 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol. Material from a separate run was used in the next step.
  • Part D
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, cesium carbonate (10.13 g, 31.07 mmol) was added to a suspension of 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (5.06 g, 20.7 mmol) in DMF (110 mL), and the reaction mixture was heated at 65° C. A solution of tert-butyl 3-iodopropylcarbamate (7.08 g, 24.8 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) was added dropwise with stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred at 65° C. overnight. The solvent was then removed under reduced pressure at 65° C. The resulting solid was partitioned between dichloromethane (250 mL) and water (250 mL). The organic layer was washed sequentially with saturated aqueous sodium thiosulfate (100 mL), water (100 mL), and brine (100 mL); dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting solid was purified by column chromatography on silica gel (eluting with 0 to 4% methanol in chloroform) to provide 5.36 g of tert-butyl 3-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • Part E
  • The method described in Part G of Example 1 was used to treat tert-butyl 3-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate (1.20 g, 2.99 mmol) with mCPBA (1.19 g of 65% pure material, 4.49 mmol) in dichloromethane (20 mL) with the modification that the reaction was stirred overnight. tert-Butyl 3-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate (1.08 g) was obtained as a light yellow solid.
  • Part F
  • A solution of tert-butyl 3-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate (1.08 g, 2.59 mmol) in 1,2-dichloroethane (25 mL) was heated in a sealed tube to 65° C., and then ammonium hydroxide (5 mL of 30% solution) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.49 g, 2.8 mmol) were added. The reaction was heated at 65° C. for 24 hours and then diluted with dichloromethane (50 mL). The resulting mixture was washed with aqueous sodium carbonate (2×50 mL of 2 M), and the combined washings were extracted with dichloromethane (2×50 mL). The combined organic layers were washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting light brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 18% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.72 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum. The solid was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (40 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 40° C. overnight to provide tert-butyl 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate as off-white needles, mp 146-149° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.66 (d, J=8.8, 1H), 7.01 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.90 (t, J=2.5, 1H), 6.88 (dd, J=9.0, 2.5, 1H), 6.77 (s, 2H), 4.05 (t, J=6.3, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.2, 2H), 3.08 (t, J=3.4, 2H), 1.90-1.78 (m, 4H), 1.36 (s, 9H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.2, 155.6, 152.3, 146.5, 139.4, 136.0, 126.6, 125.6, 113.1, 113.0, 107.2, 79.1, 77.5, 65.3, 36.9, 35.1, 29.2, 28.2, 22.8, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C21H28N4O3S: C, 60.55; H, 6.78; N, 13.45. Found: C, 60.64; H, 6.82; N, 13.57.
  • Example 5 N-{3-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propyl}methanesulfonamide
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00101
  • Part A
  • A solution of hydrogen chloride in ethanol (2 mL of 4.25 M) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propylcarbamate (0.69 g, 1.66 mmol) in ethanol (15 mL), and the reaction was heated at 80° C. for 30 minutes, allowed to cool to room temperature, and stirred overnight. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and dichloromethane (100 mL) was added. The resulting solution was washed with water (100 mL). The aqueous fraction was made basic with the addition of ammonium hydroxide, and the resulting solution was extracted with dichloromethane (2×50 mL). The organic fractions were combined, washed with brine (75 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 0.58 g of 7-(3-aminopropoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine containing some impurities.
  • Part B
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, a suspension of the material from Part A and triethylamine (0.51 mL, 3.7 mmol) in dichloromethane (25 mL) was cooled to approximately 0° C. Methanesulfonyl chloride (0.14 mL, 1.8 mmol) was added dropwise, and the reaction was allowed to slowly warm to room temperature and stirred overnight. An analysis by high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC) indicated that starting material remained. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and the residue was suspended in chloroform (80 mL) with triethylamine (5 mL). Methanesulfonyl chloride (0.14 mL, 1.8 mmol) was added, and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 5.5 hours. The reaction was monitored by HPLC, and additional methanesulfonyl chloride (0.84 mL, 11 mmol) was added over the course of four days. The reaction mixture was partitioned between chloroform (50 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic fraction was washed with brine (2×50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.17 g of N-{3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propyl}methanesulfonamide as off-white needles, mp 168-171° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.66 (d, J=8.7, 1H), 7.08 (t, J=5.9, 1H), 7.04 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 6.79 (s, 2H), 4.12 (t, J=6.2, 2H), 3.17-3.08 (m, 4H), 2.90 (s, 3H), 1.93 (sextet, J=6.6, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.2, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.1, 152.3, 146.5, 139.3, 135.9, 125.6, 113.1, 107.3, 64.9, 39.4, 39.2, 35.0, 29.2, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C17H22N4O3S2: C, 51.76; H, 5.62; N, 14.20. Found: C, 51.53; H, 5.37; N, 14.10.
  • Example 6 N-{3-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propyl}-5-(dimethylamino)naphthalene-1-sulfonamide
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00102
  • Pyridine (5 mL) and 4-dimethylaminopyridine (100 mg) were added to 7-(3-aminopropoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (0.93 g, 2.9 mmol, prepared according to the method described in Part A of Example 5) in dichloromethane (40 mL). 5-Dimethylamino-1-naphthalenesulfonyl chloride (0.95 g, 3.5 mmol, dansyl chloride) were sequentially added to the mixture, and the resulting yellow solution was stirred overnight under a nitrogen atmosphere at room temperature. An analysis by HPLC indicated the presence of starting material, and additional dansyl chloride (240 mg) was added. The reaction was stirred for two hours and then mixed with water (100 mL). The aqueous fraction was extracted with chloroform (2×100 mL), and the combined organic fractions were washed with brine (100 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 1.17 g of N-{3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propyl}-5-(dimethylamino)naphthalene-1-sulfonamide as a light yellow solid, mp 143-146° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 8.41 (d, J=8.5, 1H), 8.30 (d, J=8.8, 1H), 8.10 (dd, J=7.2, 1.3, 1H), 7.98 (t, J=6.0, 1H), 7.60-7.55 (m, 2H), 7.20 (d, J=6.9, 1H), 6.88 (d, J=2.6, 1H), 6.75 (s, 2H), 6.71 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 5.74 (s, 1H), 3.93 (t, J=6.0, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.6, 2H), 2.98 (q, J=6.7, 2H), 2.77 (s, 6H), 1.88-1.78 (m, 4H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 168.9, 158.9, 152.3, 151.3, 146.4, 139.3, 135.9, 135.8, 129.4, 129.0, 128.3, 127.7, 125.5, 123.4, 118.9, 115.0, 113.0, 112.9, 107.2, 64.6, 44.9, 39.3, 35.0, 28.9, 22.7, 13.4.
  • Example 7 7-(2-Morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00103
  • Part A
  • A solution of bromoacetyl bromide (3.0 mL, 0.034 mol) in dichloromethane (240 mL) was cooled to −25° C. A solution of morpholine (9.0 mL, 0.10 mol) in dichloromethane (20 mL) was slowly added over a period of one hour. After the addition was complete, the reaction was stirred at −25° C. for 15 minutes and allowed to warm to ambient temperature. Dichloromethane was added, and the resulting solution was washed with water, 1N aqueous hydrogen chloride, and brine; dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 4-(bromoacetyl)morpholine as a colorless oil.
  • Part B
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, cesium carbonate (4.44 g, 13.6 mmol) was added to a suspension of 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (2.22 g, 9.09 mmol) in DMF (50 mL), and the reaction mixture was heated at 75° C. for 15 minutes. A solution of 4-(bromoacetyl)morpholine (2.26 g, 10.9 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) was added dropwise with stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred at 75° C. for 2.25 hours. The solvent was then removed under reduced pressure at 75° C. The resulting solid was partitioned between dichloromethane (250 mL) and water (250 mL). The organic layer was washed sequentially with water (100 mL) and brine (100 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 2.84 g of 7-(2-morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a light yellow solid. A portion of the product (0.37 g) was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (40 mL), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 40° C. overnight to provide the following analytical data, mp 133-136° C.
  • Anal. calcd for C19H21N3O3S: C, 61.44; H, 5.70; N, 11.31. Found: C, 61.26; H, 5.74; N, 11.25.
  • Part C
  • The method described in Part G of Example 1 was used to treat 7-(2-morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (2.45 g, 6.60 mmol) with mCPBA (2.28 g of 65% pure material, 8.57 mmol) in dichloromethane (50 mL) to provide 2.58 g of 7-(2-morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a light yellow solid.
  • Part D
  • The method described in Part F of Example 4 was used to treat 7-(2-morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (2.58 g, 6.66 mmol) with ammonium hydroxide (15 mL of 30%) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.26 g, 7.33 mmol) in 1,2-dichloroethane (60 mL). The reaction was complete in four hours. The resulting light brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 5% CMA in chloroform followed by 25% CMA in chloroform) to provide 1.88 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum. The solid was recrystallized from 2-propanol (175 mL), and the crystals were washed with cold 2-propanol and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 1.54 g of 7-(2-morpholin-4-yl-2-oxoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as white needles, mp 200-203° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.68 (d, J=8.7, 1H), 7.02 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.92 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 6.80 (s, 2H), 4.93 (s, 2H), 3.61-3.47 (m, 8H), 3.11 (t, J=7.8, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.2, 2H), 1.02 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.1, 165.9, 158.5, 152.4, 146.3, 139.3, 136.0, 125.6, 113.3, 113.0, 107.7, 66.05, 65.9, 44.8, 41.6, 35.1, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C19H22N4O3S: C, 59.05; H, 5.74; N, 14.50. Found: C, 59.08; H, 5.53; N, 14.20.
  • Example 8 tert-Butyl 6-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00104
  • Part A
  • The methods described in Parts A and B of Example 4 were used to treat 6-amino-1-hexanol (10.0 g, 85.3 mmol) with di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (20.1 g, 92.2 mmol) and treat the resulting product with triphenylphosphine (26.14 g, 99.7 mmol), imidazole (7.92 g, 116.3 mmol), and iodine (27.41 g, 108.0 mmol). The resulting light yellow oil (19.36 g) was purified by column chromatography (silica gel, eluting with dichloromethane) to provide 13.53 g of tert-butyl 6-iodohexylcarbamate as a light yellow oil.
  • Part B
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, cesium carbonate (2.58 g, 7.92 mmol) was added to a suspension of 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (1.29 g, 5.28 mmol) in DMF (25 mL), and the reaction mixture was heated to 65° C. A solution of tert-butyl 6-iodohexylcarbamate (1.90 g, 5.81 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) was added dropwise with stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred at 65° C. for 5.5 hours. The solvent was then removed under reduced pressure at 65° C. The resulting solid was partitioned between dichloromethane (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was washed sequentially with saturated aqueous sodium thiosulfate (50 mL), water (50 mL), and brine (50 mL); dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 6% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 1.79 g of tert-butyl 6-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • Part C
  • The method described in Part G of Example 1 was used to treat tert-butyl 6-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate (1.80 g, 4.06 mmol) with mCPBA (1.62 g of 65% pure material, 6.09 mmol) in dichloromethane (30 mL) with the modification that the reaction was stirred for 2.5 hours. tert-Butyl 6-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate (1.79 g) was obtained as a light yellow solid.
  • Part D
  • The method described in Part F of Example 4 was used to treat tert-butyl 6-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate (1.79 g, 3.90 mmol) with ammonium hydroxide (8 mL of 30%) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.74 g, 4.3 mmol) in 1,2-dichloroethane (40 mL). The reaction was stirred for one hour at 65° C., allowed to come to room temperature, and stirred overnight. The purification methods described in Part F of Example 4 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 15% CMA in chloroform, to provide 1.06 g of tert-butyl 6-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate as off-white needles, mp 136-139° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.64 (d, J=8.7, 1H), 7.01 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.88 (dd, J=9.0, 2.5, 1H), 6.77 (m, 3H), 4.03 (t, J=6.6, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.5, 2H), 2.90 (q, J=6.6, 2H), 1.90-1.71 (m, 4H), 1.39-1.30 (m, 15H), 1.00 (t, J=7.1, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 168.9, 159.3, 155.5, 152.3, 146.5, 139.4, 135.9, 125.6, 113.1, 113.0, 107.2, 77.2, 67.4, 35.1, 29.4, 28.6, 28.2, 26.0, 25.2, 22.8, 13.4; Anal. calcd for C24H34N4O3S: C, 62.85; H, 7.47; N, 12.22. Found: C, 62.80; H, 7.36; N, 12.18.
  • Example 9 N-{6-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexyl}methanesulfonamide
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00105
  • Part A
  • A solution of hydrogen chloride in ethanol (3 mL of 4.25 M) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl 6-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexylcarbamate (0.93 g, 2.0 mmol) in ethanol (20 mL), and the reaction was heated at 80° C. for one hour, allowed to cool to room temperature, and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure. The residue was partitioned between water (50 mL) and dichloromethane (30 mL) was added. The aqueous fraction was made basic with the addition of ammonium hydroxide, and the resulting solution was extracted with dichloromethane (2×50 mL). The organic fractions were combined, washed with brine (75 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 0.73 g of 7-[(6-aminohexyl)oxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine.
  • Part B
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, methanesulfonyl chloride (0.35 mL, 4.1 mmol) was added dropwise to a suspension of 7-[(6-aminohexyl)oxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (0.73 g, 2.0 mmol) and triethylamine (5 mL, 36 mmol) in chloroform (50 mL), and the reaction was stirred overnight. The work-up procedure described in Part B of Example 5 was followed. The resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.47 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum. The solid was recrystallized from toluene (25 mL), and the crystals were washed with cold toluene and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.32 g of N-{6-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]hexyl}methanesulfonamide as off-white needles, mp 138-134° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.64 (d, J=8.7, 1H), 7.02 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.92 (t, J=5.9, 1H), 6.88 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 6.78 (s, 2H), 4.04 (t, J=6.4, 2H), 3.10 (t, J=7.5, 2H), 2.92 (q, J=6.6, 2H), 2.86 (s, 3H), 1.90-1.70 (m, 4H) 1.53-1.33 (m, 6H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 168.9, 159.3, 152.3, 146.5, 139.4, 135.9, 125.6, 113.1, 113.0, 107.2, 67.4, 42.4, 39.2, 35.1, 29.3, 28.5, 25.9, 25.2, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C20H28N4O3S2: C, 55.02; H, 6.46; N, 12.83. Found: C, 55.20; H, 6.80; N, 12.68.
  • Example 10 tert-Butyl 2-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00106
  • Part A
  • A solution of 2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethanol (15.0 g, 143 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (THF) (90 mL) was cooled to approximately 0° C., and aqueous sodium hydroxide (72 mL of 2 M) was added over a period of 20 minutes. A solution of di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (31.1 g, 143 mmol) in THF (90 mL) was then added over a period of 20 minutes. The reaction was stirred for one hour at 0° C. and then allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred overnight. The THF was removed under reduced pressure, and the resulting aqueous mixture was adjusted to pH 3 with the addition of 1 M sulfuric acid. The acidic mixture was extracted with ethyl acetate (3×100 mL), and the combined extracts were washed sequentially with water (150 mL) and brine (150 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 27.1 g of tert-butyl 2-(2-hydroxyethoxy)ethylcarbamate as a colorless oil. A portion of the oil (10.0 g, 48.7 mmol) was treated with triphenylphosphine (15.33 g, 58.45 mmol), imidazole (4.64 g, 68.2 mmol), and iodine (16.01 g, 63.3 mmol) according to the method described in Part B of Example 4, with the modification that dichloromethane (325 mL) was used instead of diethyl ether and acetonitrile, to provide 7.82 g of tert-butyl 2-(2-iodoethoxy)ethylcarbamate containing a small amount of triphenylphosphine oxide.
  • Part B
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, cesium carbonate (1.50 g, 4.61 mmol) was added to a suspension of 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (0.75 g, 3.1 mmol) in DMF (15 mL), and the reaction mixture was heated at 75° C. for 30 minutes. A solution of tert-butyl 2-(2-iodoethoxy)ethylcarbamate (1.93 g, 6.14 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) was added dropwise with stirring. The reaction mixture was stirred at 75° C. for 3.75 hours. The solvent was then removed under reduced pressure at 65° C. The resulting solid was partitioned between dichloromethane (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate; filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting dark brown solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 8% CMA in chloroform), and the purified product was dried under high vacuum to provide 1.31 g of tert-butyl 2-{2-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • Part C
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, mCPBA (1.20 g, 4.30 mmol, 65% pure) was added in portions to a solution of tert-butyl 2-{2-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate (1.25 g, 2.90 mmol) in dichloromethane (75 mL), and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 1.75 hours, diluted with chloroform (100 mL), and washed with 10% aqueous sodium carbonate (2×50 mL). The aqueous layer was extracted with chloroform (50 mL), and the combined organic fractions were washed with water (75 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, concentrated under reduced pressure, and dried under high vacuum to yield 1.23 g of tert-butyl 2-{2-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • Part D
  • The method described in Part F of Example 4 was used to treat tert-butyl 2-{2-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate (1.23 g, 2.75 mmol) with ammonium hydroxide (5 mL of 30%) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (0.58 g, 3.0 mmol) in 1,2-dichloroethane (25 mL) with the modifications that the reaction was allowed to run for 16 hours, and chloroform was used instead of dichloromethane in the work-up procedure. The purification methods described in Part F of Example 4 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform, to provide 0.583 g of tert-butyl 2-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate as light yellow needles, mp 111-113° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.66 (d, J=8.8, 1H), 7.02 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 2H), 6.79 (s, 2H), 4.17 (t, J=4.3, 2H), 3.76 (t, J=4.7, 2H), 3.46 (t, J=5.9, 2H), 3.09 (m, 4H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.36 (s, 9H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.1, 159.0, 155.6, 152.4, 146.5, 139.4, 136.0, 125.7, 113.1, 107.2, 77.6, 69.3, 68.6, 67.1, 35.1, 28.2, 22.8, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C22H30N4O4S: C, 59.17; H, 6.77; N, 12.55. Found: C, 58.88; H, 6.87; N, 12.64.
  • Example 11 N-(2-{2-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethyl)methanesulfonamide
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00107
  • Part A
  • The method described in Part A of Example 9 was used to treat tert-butyl 2-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethylcarbamate (0.74 g, 1.7 mmol) in ethanol (20 mL) with hydrogen chloride (3 mL of a 4.25 M solution in ethanol) to provide 0.63 g of 7-[2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a light yellow solid.
  • Part B
  • The method described in Part B of Example 9 was used to treat 7-[2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (0.63 g, 1.8 mmol) in chloroform (40 mL) with triethylamine (2.5 mL, 18 mmol) and methanesulfonyl chloride (0.300 mL, 3.64 mmol); the reaction was complete in 3.5 hours. The purification methods described in Part B of Example 9 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 30% CMA in chloroform, to provide 0.40 g of N-(2-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethoxy}ethyl)methanesulfonamide as off-white needles, mp 134-137° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.66 (d, J=8.7, 1H), 7.07 (t, J=5.6, 1H), 7.03 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.7, 2.5, 1H), 6.80 (s, 2H), 4.19 (t, J=4.3, 2H), 3.79 (t, J=4.7, 2H), 3.55 (t, J=5.9, 2H), 3.16-3.08 (m, 4H), 2.91 (s, 3H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.0, 152.4, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.7, 113.1, 113.0, 107.2, 69.8, 68.7, 67.1, 42.3, 39.7, 35.1, 22.8, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C18H24N4O4S2: C, 50.92; H, 5.70; N, 13.20. Found: C, 51.20; H, 5.48; N, 13.14.
  • Example 12 tert-Butyl 2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00108
  • Part A
  • The methods described in Parts A and B of Example 4 were used to treat 2-amino-1-ethanol with di-tert-butyl dicarbonate and treat the resulting product (10.0 g, 62.0 mmol) with triphenylphosphine (19.52 g, 74.5 mmol), imidazole (5.91 g, 86.9 mmol), and iodine (20.47 g, 80.65 mmol), with the modification that dichloromethane (400 mL) was used in the second step instead of diethyl ether and acetonitrile. The product, tert-butyl 2-iodoethylcarbamate (8.41 g) was obtained as a light yellow oil.
  • Part B
  • The method described in Part B of Example 10 was used to treat 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (2.94 g, 12.0 mmol) in DMF (40 mL) with cesium carbonate (5.88 g, 18.0 mmol) and a solution of tert-butyl 2-iodoethylcarbamate (4.89 g, 18.0 mmol) in DMF (10 mL). The reaction was complete in 3.25 hours. The purification methods described in Part B of Example 10 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 4% CMA in chloroform, to provide 3.85 g of tert-butyl 2-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate as a light yellow solid.
  • Part C
  • The method described in Part C of Example 10 was used to treat tert-butyl 2-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate (3.85 g, 9.94 mmol) with mCPBA (2.57 g of 65% pure material, 14.9 mmol) in dichloromethane to provide 4.01 g of tert-butyl 2-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate as a light orange solid.
  • Part D
  • The method described in Part F of Example 4 was used to treat tert-butyl 2-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate (4.01 g, 9.94 mmol) with ammonium hydroxide (17 mL of 30%) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (2.08 g, 10.9 mmol) in 1,2-dichloroethane (85 mL). The reaction was complete in 4.5 hours. The purification methods described in Part F of Example 4 were used to provide 2.84 g of tert-butyl 2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate as light yellow needles, mp 136-139° C. 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.66 (d, J=8.5, 11H), 7.02 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 7.01 (s, 1H), 6.89 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 6.80 (s, 2H), 4.04 (t, J=5.8, 2H), 3.33 (q, J=5.7, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.6, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.38 (s, 9H), 1.00 (t, J=7.2, 3H); 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.0, 155.6, 152.4, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.7, 131.1, 113.0, 107.3, 77.7, 66.4, 35.1, 28.2, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C20H26N4O3S: C, 59.68; H, 6.51; N, 13.92. Found: C, 59.59; H, 6.18; N, 13.88.
  • Example 13 N-{2-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}methanesulfonamide
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00109
  • Part A
  • A solution of hydrogen chloride in ethanol (15 mL of 2.2 M) was added to a suspension of tert-butyl 2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethylcarbamate (2.57 g, 6.38 mmol) in ethanol (60 mL), and the reaction was heated at 80° C. overnight. A precipitate began to form after about ten minutes. The solvent was removed under reduced pressure, and the resulting solid was suspended in ethanol (25 mL), isolated by filtration, washed with ethanol, and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 2.06 of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride as a light yellow solid.
  • Part B
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, methanesulfonyl chloride (0.20 mL, 2.5 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride (0.64 g, 1.9 mmol) and triethylamine (0.53 mL, 3.8 mmol) in chloroform (40 mL), and the reaction was stirred for 1.25 hours. The work-up procedure described in Part B of Example 5 was followed. The resulting light yellow solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.73 g of an off-white solid after drying under high vacuum. The solid was recrystallized from propyl acetate (35 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold propyl acetate and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.48 g of N-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}methanesulfonamide as light yellow needles, mp 148-151° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.68 (d, J=8.7, 1H), 7.30 (t, J=6.0, 11H), 7.03 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.92 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 6.81 (s, 2H), 4.13 (t, J=5.6, 2H), 3.38 (q, J=5.6, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.1, 2H), 2.95 (s, 3H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.2, 3H); 13C NMR (75 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.1, 158.8, 152.4, 146.5, 139.36, 136.0, 125.8, 113.2, 112.9, 107.3, 79.1, 66.9, 41.8, 35.1, 22.8, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C16H20N4O3S2: C, 50.51; H, 5.30; N, 14.72. Found: C, 50.78; H, 5.10; N, 14.67.
  • Example 14 N,N′-Bis{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}urea
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00110
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, a suspension of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride (0.60 g, 2.0 mmol) and carbonyldiimidazole (150 mg, 0.95 mmol) in DMF was heated at 75° C. for four hours. Upon heating a solution formed, and a precipitate began to form after about 30 minutes. The reaction mixture was then combined with material from a smaller run, and the DMF was removed under reduced pressure at 65° C. Water (50 mL) was added to the residue, and the resulting solid was isolated by filtration, washed with water, methanol (25 mL) and tert-butyl methyl ether (25 mL), and dried overnight in a vacuum oven at 80° C. A portion of the solid (250 mg) was suspended in warm DMF (25 mL) and filtered. The DMF was removed under reduced pressure at 65° C. The resulting solid was suspended in chloroform (10 mL), isolated by filtration, washed with chloroform, and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 0.14 mg of N,N-bis{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}urea as a light yellow solid, mp 213-216° C. 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.61 (d, J=8.8, 2H), 7.03 (d, J=2.6, 2H), 6.89 (dd, J=8.5, 2.2, 2H), 6.81 (s, 4H), 6.28 (t, J=5.3, 2H), 4.06 (t, J=5.6, 4H), 3.44 (q, J=5.4, 4H), 3.10 (t, J=7.3, 4H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.6, 4H), 1.00 (t, J=7.2, 6H); 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.0, 158.0, 152.4, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.7, 113.1, 112.9, 107.4, 67.4, 38.8, 35.1, 22.7, 13.4; HRMS (EI) m/z calcd for C31H34N8O3S2:631.2274; found: 631.2283.
  • Example 15 Bis{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}ether
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00111
  • The method described in Part K of Example 1 was used to treat 4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol acetic acid salt (prepared according to the method described in Part J of Example 1, 1.17 g, 4.51 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) with cesium carbonate (3.27 g, 10.0 mmol) and 2-chloroethylether (288 mg, 2.01 mmol) with the modification that the reaction was carried out at 70° C. instead of 75° C. The purification methods described in Part K of Example 1 were used, with the modification that chromatographic purification was carried out eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform. Following recrystallization from tert-butyl methyl ether, the solid (0.38 g) was recrystallized from 2-butanone (40 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold 2-butanone and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 0.21 g of bis{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}ether as light yellow needles, mp 186-189° C. 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.63 (d, J=8.7, 2H), 7.05 (d, J=2.5, 2H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.7, 2.5, 2H), 6.80 (s, 4H), 4.22 (m, 4H), 3.88 (m, 4H), 3.10 (t, J=7.5, 4H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 4H), 1.00 (t, J=7.2, 6H); 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.0, 159.0, 152.4, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.7, 113.1, 113.0, 107.3, 69.0, 67.2, 35.1, 22.7, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C30H32N6O3S2 0.5H2O: C, 60.30; H, 5.56; N, 14.06. Found: C, 60.54; H, 5.48; N, 14.16.
  • Example 16 7-[2-(2-Chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00112
  • Part A
  • The method described in Part B of Example 10 was used to treat 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (1.10 g, 4.50 mmol) in DMF (17 mL) with cesium carbonate (1.76 g, 5.40 mmol) and a solution of 1-chloro-2-(2-iodoethoxy)ethane (1.27 g, 5.40 mmol) in DMF (5 mL). The reaction was complete in 2.75 hours. The purification methods described in Part B of Example 10 were used to provide 1.18 g of 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a light yellow solid.
  • Part B
  • The method described in Part C of Example 10 was used to treat 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (1.2 g, 3.4 mmol) with mCPBA (1.36 g of 65% pure material, 5.13 mmol) in dichloromethane (30 mL). The reaction was complete in 2.5 hours, and 1.03 g of 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline were obtained as a light orange solid.
  • Part C
  • The methods described in Parts H and I of Example 1 were used to treat 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (1.03 g, 2.81 mmol) in dichloromethane (20 mL) with trichloroacetyl isocyanate (0.40 mL) followed by sodium methoxide (2 mL of a 25% w/w solution in methanol) in methanol (20 mL). The reaction with sodium methoxide was complete within 45 minutes. The crude solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 20% CMA in chloroform) to provide 0.93 g of a light yellow solid after drying under high vacuum. The solid was recrystallized from tert-butyl methyl ether (35 mL, hot filtration), and the crystals were washed with cold tert-butyl methyl ether and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 0.23 g of 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a light yellow solid, mp 101-103° C. 1H NMR (300 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.67 (d, J=8.8, 1H), 7.03 (t, J=2.5, 1H), 6.91 (dd, J=8.7, 2.5, 1H), 6.79 (s, 2H), 4.19 (t, J=4.3, 2H), 3.83 (t, J=4.7, 2H), 3.75 (s, 4H), 3.11 (t, J=7.8, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.5, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.5, 3H); 13C NMR (75 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.5, 159.4, 152.8, 146.9, 139.8, 136.4, 126.1, 113.6, 113.5, 107.7, 71.0, 69.2, 67.6, 43.9, 35.5, 23.1, 13.8;
  • Anal. calcd for C17H20N3O2SCl: C, 55.81; H, 5.51; N, 11.48. Found: C, 55.74; H, 5.40; N, 11.29.
  • Examples 17-55
  • A reagent from the table below (1.1 equivalents, 0.11 mmol) was added to a test tube containing a solution of 7-[2-(2-aminoethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (prepared as described in Part A of Example 11, 35 mg, 0.10 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (36 μL, 0.20 mmol) in N,N-dimethylacetamide (DMA) (1 mL). Each test tube was capped and placed on a shaker at room temperature four hours. Two drops of water were added to each test tube, and then the solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by preparative high performance liquid chromatography (prep HPLC) using a Waters FractionLynx automated purification system. The prep HPLC fractions were analyzed using a Waters LC/TOF-MS, and the appropriate fractions were centrifuge evaporated to provide the trifluoroacetate salt of the desired compound. Reversed phase prep HPLC was performed with non-linear gradient elution from 5-95% B where A is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/water and B is 0.05% trifluoroacetic acid/acetonitrile. Fractions were collected by mass-selective triggering. The table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, isocyanate, isothiocyanate, or carbamoyl chloride used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Examples 17-55
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00113
    Measured
    Exam- Mass
    ple Reagent R (M + H)
    17 None
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00114
    347.1506
    18 Acetyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00115
    389.1625
    19 Propionylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00116
    403.1834
    20 Methylchloroformate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00117
    405.1556
    21 Cyclopropane-carbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00118
    415.1840
    22 Butyryl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00119
    417.1925
    23 Cyclohexane-carbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00120
    457.2274
    24 Hydrocinnamoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00121
    479.2126
    25 o-Anisoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00122
    481.1924
    26 m-Anisoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00123
    481.1951
    27 2-Chlorobenzoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00124
    485.1414
    28 3-Chlorobenzoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00125
    485.1414
    29 4-Chlorobenzoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00126
    485.1433
    30 Nicotinoylchloridehydrochloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00127
    452.1743
    31 Picolinoylchloridehydrochloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00128
    452.1712
    32 Methanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00129
    425.1312
    33 Ethanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00130
    439.1498
    34 1-Propanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00131
    453.1635
    35 Benzenesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00132
    487.1468
    36 1-Methyl-imidazole-4-sulfonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00133
    491.1534
    37 3-Cyanobenzene-sulfonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00134
    512.1421
    38 4-Cyanobenzene-sulfonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00135
    512.1395
    39 3-Methoxy-benzenesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00136
    517.1613
    40 4-Methoxy-benzenesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00137
    517.1620
    41 2-Chloro-benzenesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00138
    521.1098
    42 3-Chlorobenzene-sulfonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00139
    521.1101
    43 4-Chlorobenzene-sulfonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00140
    521.1088
    44 Cyclopropylisothiocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00141
    446.1678
    45 Cyclopentylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00142
    458.2220
    46 Cyclopropyl-methylisothiocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00143
    460.1844
    47 Phenyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00144
    466.1903
    48 Cyclohexylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00145
    472.2347
    49 Phenylisothiocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00146
    482.1696
    50 2-Phenylethylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00147
    494.2235
    51 2-Methoxyphenylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00148
    496.1979
    52 3-Methoxyphenylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00149
    496.2054
    53 4-Methoxyphenylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00150
    496.1994
    54 N,N-Dimethyl-carbamoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00151
    418.1894
    55 1-Piperidine-carbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00152
    458.2241
  • Examples 56-101
  • An amine (0.15 mmol, 1.5 equivalents) from the table below was added to a test tube containing 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (prepared as described in Example 16, 37 mg, 0.10 mmol) and potassium carbonate (55 mg, 0.40 mmol) in DMA (1 mL). Each tube was capped and heated at 70° C. for 16 hours. An analysis by liquid chromatography/mass spectrometry (LC/MS) indicated the presence of starting material for Examples 59 and 74; therefore, each reaction was heated at 85° C. for six additional hours. Each reaction mixture was filtered, and the filter cake was washed with DMA (0.250 mL). The solvent was then removed from the filtrate by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified using the method described in Examples 17-55. The table below shows the amine added to each test tube, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Examples 56-101
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00153
    Ex- Measured
    am- Mass
    ple Reagent R (M + H)
    56 None
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00154
    366.1057
    57 Pyrrolidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00155
    401.2044
    58 Piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00156
    415.2173
    59 Morpholine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00157
    417.1958
    60 3-Methyl-piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00158
    429.2318
    61 4-Methyl-piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00159
    429.2327
    62 Hexamethylene-imine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00160
    429.2340
    63 1-Methyl-piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00161
    430.2311
    64 3-Hydroxy-piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00162
    431.2148
    65 4-Hydroxy-piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00163
    431.2130
    66 Thiomorpholine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00164
    433.1730
    67 N-Methylcyclo-hexylamine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00165
    443.2473
    68 3-(Dimethyl-amino)pyrrolidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00166
    444.2450
    69 N,N′-Dimethyl-3-aminopyrrolidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00167
    444.2456
    70 1-Ethylpiperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00168
    444.2440
    71 N-Methylhomo-piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00169
    444.2461
    72 2-Piperidine-methanol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00170
    445.2307
    73 3-(Hydroxy-methyl)piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00171
    445.2292
    74 4-(Hydroxy-methyl)piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00172
    445.2270
    75 N-Methylbenzyl-amine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00173
    451.2189
    76 3-Azabicyclo[3.2.2]nonane
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00174
    455.2492
    77 Nipecotamide
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00175
    458.2202
    78 (3S)-(−)-3-Acetamido-pyrrolidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00176
    458.2253
    79 1-Acetyl-piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00177
    458.2245
    80 1-Methyl-4-(methylamino)piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00178
    458.2549
    81 Nipecotic acid
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00179
    459.2078
    82 2-Piperidine-ethanol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00180
    459.2423
    83 4-Piperidine-ethanol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00181
    459.2415
    84 N-(2-Hydroxy-ethyl)piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00182
    460.2406
    85 1,2,3,4-Tetra-hydroiso-quinoline
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00183
    463.2170
    86 (R)-(+)-N-Methyl-1-phenyl-ethylamine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00184
    465.2357
    87 (S)-(−)-N-Methyl-1-phenylethyl-amine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00185
    465.2369
    88 N-Methylphenyl-ethylamine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00186
    465.2354
    89 2-(2-Methyl-aminoethyl)pyridine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00187
    466.2282
    90 Decahydroiso-quinoline
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00188
    469.2622
    91 Decahydro-quinoline
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00189
    469.2635
    92 1-(2-Methoxy-ethyl)piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00190
    474.2541
    93 alpha-(Methyl-aminomethyl)benzyl alcohol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00191
    481.2299
    94 4-(1-Pyrrolidinyl)piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00192
    484.2756
    95 4-Phenyl-piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00193
    491.2474
    96 1-Phenyl-piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00194
    492.2400
    97 1-(2-Pyridyl)piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00195
    493.2390
    98 1-(4-Pyridyl)-piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00196
    493.2389
    99 1-(2-Pyrimdyl)piperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00197
    494.2330
    100  4-Piperidino-piperidine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00198
    498.2913
    101  1-Hydroxyethyl-ethoxypiperazine
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00199
    504.2670
  • Example 102 7-[2-(1,1-Dioxidoisothiazolidin-2-yl)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00200
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, 3-chloropropanesulfonyl chloride (0.30 mL, 2.4 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride (0.75 g, 2.2 mmol), prepared as described in Example 13 Part A, and triethylamine (0.68 mL, 4.9 mmol) in chloroform (50 mL), and the heterogeneous reaction was stirred overnight at room temperature. An analysis by HPLC indicated the presence of starting material, and additional triethylamine (0.68 mL, 4.9 mmol) was added. The resulting solution was stirred for 2.5 hours at room temperature, diluted with chloroform (100 mL), washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide an orange solid. The solid was dissolved in DMF (15 mL), and the solution was heated to 50° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere, 1,8-Diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene (DBU) (0.42 mL, 2.8 mmol) was added in one portion, and the reaction was stirred at 50° C. for 2.75 hours. The DMF was removed under reduced pressure at 65° C., and the residue was partitioned between chloroform (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was separated and washed sequentially with water (50 mL) and brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from propyl acetate (25 mL for 0.35 g). The crystals were washed with cold propyl acetate and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.156 g of 7-[2-(1,1-dioxidoisothiazolidin-2-yl)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a light yellow solid, mp 127-130° C.
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.68 (d, J=8.9, 1H), 7.04 (d, J=2.2, 1H), 6.91 (dd, J=8.8, 2.5, 1H), 6.81 (s, 2H), 4.22 (t, J=5.0, 2H), 3.37-3.28 (m, 4H), 3.19 (t, J=7.6, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.6, 2H), 2.24 (quintet, J=7.0, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.3, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.6, 3H);
  • 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 169.1, 158.7, 152.4, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.8, 113.2, 113.0, 107.4, 66.2, 47.7, 45.7, 43.8, 35.1, 22.8, 18.5, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C18H22N4O3S2: C, 53.18; H, 5.46; N, 13.78. Found: C, 53.27; H, 5.41; N, 13.66.
  • Example 103 N-{2-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}acrylamide
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00201
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, 3-chloropropionyl chloride (0.28 mL, 2.9 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride (0.90 g, 2.7 mmol), prepared as described in Example 13 Part A, and triethylamine (2.0 mL, 15 mmol) in chloroform (50 mL), and the solution was stirred for 3.5 hours at room temperature. The intermediate was isolated, dissolved in DMF, and treated with DBU (0.50 mL, 3.3 mmol), as described in Example 102 with the modification that the reaction with DBU was heated for 5.25 hours. After the work-up procedure, described in Example 102, the crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 28% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile (50 mL for 0.67 g). The crystals were washed with cold acetonitrile and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. overnight to provide 0.426 g of N-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}acrylamide as a light yellow solid, mp 200-202° C.
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.51 (d, J=8.9, 1H), 7.00 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.86 (dd, J=8.9, 2.5, 1H), 6.18 (dd, J=17.0, 1.6, 1H), 6.09 (dd, J=17.0, 10.7, 1H), 5.56 (dd, J=10.1, 1.9, 1H), 4.08 (t, J=5.3, 2H), 3.36-3.64 (m, 5H), 3.00 (t, J=7.6, 2H), 1.83 (sextet, J=7.3, 2H), 0.97 (t, J=7.6, 3H);
  • 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 170.3, 166.4, 159.4, 151.8, 145.3, 140.9, 136.0, 130.3, 126.5, 125.6, 114.0, 113.8, 107.1, 66.4, 38.7, 35.7, 23.0, 13.3;
  • Anal. calcd for C18H20N4O2S: C, 60.65; H, 5.66; N, 15.72. Found: C, 60.64; H, 5.60; N, 15.70.
  • Example 104 N-{2-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}pyrrolidin-2-one
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00202
  • Under a nitrogen atmosphere, 4-chlorobutyryl chloride (0.30 mL, 2.6 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride (0.81 g, 2.4 mmol), prepared as described in Example 13 Part A, and triethylamine (1.8 mL, 13 mmol) in chloroform (50 mL), and the solution was stirred for 2.5 hours at room temperature. The intermediate was isolated as an orange solid using the procedure described in Example 102. A solution of the orange solid in DMF (15 mL) was slowly added to a mixture of sodium hydride (120 mg of a 60% dispersion in mineral oil, 3.0 mmol) in DMF (5 mL) that had been cooled to 0° C. The resulting mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 15 minutes, allowed to warm to room temperature, and stirred overnight. The DMF was removed under reduced pressure at 65° C., and the residue was partitioned between chloroform (100 mL) and water (100 mL). The organic layer was separated and washed with brine (50 mL), dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0 to 25% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile (25 mL for 0.37 g). The crystals were washed with cold acetonitrile and dried in a vacuum oven at 60° C. to provide 290 mg of N-{2-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]ethyl}pyrrolidin-2-one as a light yellow solid, mp 163-166° C.
  • 1H NMR (500 MHz, d6-DMSO) δ 7.67 (d, J=8.5, 1H), 7.04 (d, J=2.5, 1H), 6.89 (dd, J=8.9, 2.5, 1H), 6.81 (s, 2H), 4.17 (t, J=5.7, 2H), 3.58 (t, J=5.4, 2H), 3.47 (t, J=6.9, 2H), 3.11 (t, J=7.5, 2H), 2.21 (t, J=7.8, 2H), 1.94 (quintet, J=7.3, 2H), 1.84 (sextet, J=7.2, 2H), 1.00 (t, J=7.3, 3H);
  • 13C NMR (125 Hz, d6-DMSO) δ 174.1, 169.1, 158.8, 152.4, 146.5, 139.3, 136.0, 125.7, 113.2, 113.0, 107.4, 65.5, 47.3, 41.4, 35.1, 30.2, 22.7, 17.6, 13.4;
  • Anal. calcd for C19H22N4O2S: C, 61.60; H, 5.99; N, 15.12. Found: C, 61.38; H, 6.18; N, 15.23.
  • Example 105 2-[(4-Amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]-1-thien-3-ylethanone
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00203
  • Part A
  • A Parr vessel was charged with 7-benzyloxy-3-nitroquinolin-7-ol (50.0 g, 169 mmol), anhydrous DMF (500 mL), and 5% platinum on carbon (5.0 g). The vessel was placed on Parr apparatus, evacuated, and charged with hydrogen gas (approximately 45 psi, 3.1×105 Pa). The reaction mixture was shaken overnight and filtered to remove the catalyst. To the resulting dark colored solution was added concentrated aqueous hydrochloric acid (14 mL of 12 N solution). A precipitate formed, and the reaction mixture was stirred over the weekend. The solid was collected by vacuum filtration, washed with diethyl ether (100 mL), and air-dried overnight to provide 44 g of 3-amino-7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol hydrochloride.
  • Part B
  • To a stirred solution of 3-amino-7-benzyloxyquinolin-4-ol hydrochloride (40.4 g, 133 mmol) and triethylamine (33.8 g, 334 mmol) in dichloromethane (1000 mL) at room temperature, was slowly added propionyl chloride (13.6 g, 147 mmol). After the reaction was stirred for six hours, water (250 mL) was added. The organic layer was separated and concentrated to provide 41.5 g of N-(7-benzyloxy-4-hydroxyquinolin-3-yl)propionamide as a pale tan, crystalline solid. MS (ACPI) m/z 323 (M+H)+.
  • Part C
  • To a stirred suspension of the material from Part B in pyridine (500 mL) was added phosphorus pentasulfide (28.6 g, 64.4 mmol). The reaction mixture was heated to reflux and became homogeneous and dark orange. The reaction was heated at reflux overnight and then allowed to cool to room temperature. Aqueous sodium carbonate (50 mL of 10% w/w) was slowly added. The resulting mixture was partitioned between water (200 mL) and dichloromethane (700 mL). The aqueous layer was separated and extracted with dichloromethane (3×100 mL). The organic fractions were combined and concentrated under reduced pressure. The resulting tan solid was treated with boiling heptane (3×400 mL) and filtered. The heptane filtrates were combined and concentrated to provide 15 g of 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a pale yellow crystalline solid. MS (ACPI) m/z=321 (M+H)+.
  • Part D
  • mCPBA (16.15 g of 50% pure material, 47 mmol) was slowly added in small portions to a stirred solution of 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (15.0 g, 46.8 mmol) in chloroform (150 mL). The reaction was stirred at room temperature overnight, washed with 10% aqueous sodium carbonate (2×50 mL), and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide 15.4 g of 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl-5-oxido[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline as a light tan solid. MS (ACPI) m/z=337 (M+H)+.
  • Part E
  • Trichloroacetyl isocyanate (5.6 mL, 46.8 mmol) was slowly added to a vigorously stirred pale orange solution of 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl-5-oxido[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinoline (15.0 g, 44.6 mmol) in dichloromethane (200 mL) at room temperature. The solution was maintained at room temperature for 18 hours, and then concentrated ammonium hydroxide solution (60 mL) was added. An off-white precipitate formed and was collected by vacuum filtration. Recrystallization from acetonitrile provided 11.3 g of 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a white crystalline solid, mp 208-209° C. MS (APCI) m/z 336.1 (M+H)+; Anal. calcd for C19H17N3OS: C, 68.03; H, 5.11; N, 12.53. Found: C, 67.45; H, 4.83; N, 12.41.
  • Part F
  • Hydrogen bromide in acetic acid (40 mL of 45% w/w) was added to 7-benzyloxy-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (11.3 g, 33.7 mmol), and the resulting solution was heated at 65° C. for two hours and then cooled in an ice bath. Aqueous sodium hydroxide (50% w/w solution) was added slowly to adjust the solution to pH 7, and a pale yellow-green solid formed. The solid was isolated by filtration and air-dried to provide 8.4 g of 4-amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol. MS (APCI) m/z 246.0 (M+H)+.
  • Part G
  • A mixture of 4-amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (245 mg, 1.0 mmol), cesium carbonate (1.3 g, 4.0 mmol), and DMF (20 mL) was stirred at 75° C. for ten minutes. 2-Bromo-1-(3-thienyl)-1-ethanone (225 mg, 1.1 mmol) was added in portions over a period of 30 minutes. The reaction mixture was stirred for two hours, allowed to cool, and diluted with water (250 mL). A precipitate formed. The mixture was stirred for one hour, and the solid was isolated by filtration. The isolated solid was rinsed with water and then dried to provide a brown powder. This material was dissolved in dichloromethane and then purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with a gradient of 0% to 20% CMA in chloroform over 700 mL and then with 200 mL of 20% CMA in chloroform.) The resulting solid was recrystallized from acetonitrile to provide 115 mg of 2-[(4-amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]-1-thien-3-ylethanone as an off-white solid, mp 202.0-203.0° C.
  • MS (ESI) m/z 370 (M+H)+;
  • Anal. calcd for C18H15N3O2S2: C, 58.52; H, 4.09; N, 11.37. Found C, 58.44; H, 3.91; N, 11.32.
  • Example 106 7-{3-[(4-Amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propoxy}-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00204
  • Part A
  • A mixture of 4-amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (1.00 g, 4.08 mmol), cesium carbonate (5.30 g, 16.3 mmol), and DMF (40 mL) was stirred at 50° C. for ten minutes. A solution of 1-bromo-3-chloropropane (705 mg, 4.48 mmol) in DMF (1.1 mL) was added in portions (0.05 mL) every seven minutes. After two hours, the reaction mixture was poured into water (225 mL). The mixture was stirred for 30 minutes and then filtered. The isolated solid was dried to provide 785 mg of 7-(3-chloropropoxy)-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as a brown solid.
  • Part B
  • A solution of 7-(3-chloropropoxy)-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (684 mg, 2.12 mmol) in DMF (20 mL) was heated to 110° C. Sodium azide (151 mg, 2.33 mol) was added in a single portion. After one hour the reaction mixture was poured into water (100 mL). The mixture was extracted with chloroform (3×100 mL). The combined extracts were concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was dissolved in chloroform and purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (eluting with a gradient of 0% to 20% CMA in chloroform over 700 mL and then with 20% CMA in chloroform for 600 mL). The major product isolated from the column fractions was 7-(3-azidopropoxy)-2-ethylthiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (400 mg). A second product isolated from the column was triturated with hot acetonitrile containing a small amount of methanol, and the mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature. The resulting solid was isolated by filtration to provide 75 mg of 7-{3-[(4-amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propoxy}-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as an off-white solid, mp 242.0-243.0° C.
  • MS (APCI) m/z 531 (M+H)+;
  • Anal. calcd for C27H26N6O2S2: C, 61.11; H, 4.94; N, 15.84. Found C, 60.90; H, 4.72; N, 15.71.
  • Example 107 3-[(4-Amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propan-1-ol
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00205
  • A mixture of 4-amino-2-ethyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol acetic acid salt (see Parts A through J of Example 1) (0.640 g, 2.01 mmol), cesium carbonate (2.6 g, 8.0 mmol), and DMF (20 mL) was stirred at 75° C. for ten minutes. A solution of 1-bromo-3-chloropropane (0.350 g, 2.21 mmol) in DMF (10 mL) was added dropwise over a period of 30 minutes. The reaction was stirred at 75° C. for three hours, allowed to cool to room temperature, and poured into deionized water (200 mL). Brine (25 mL) was added, and a precipitate formed. The resulting mixture was stirred for one hour, and the solid was then collected by filtration. The solid was stirred in a mixture of potassium carbonate and methanol overnight, and the mixture was then filtered through a 0.2 micron TEFLON filter. Chloroform was added during the filtration. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure, and the residue was partitioned between chloroform and water. The organic fraction was concentrated under reduced pressure, and the residue was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (eluting with a gradient of 0% to 20% CMA in chloroform over 900 mL and then with 20% CMA in chloroform for 500 mL). The resulting solid (400 mg) was recrystallized from acetonitrile to provide 100 mg of 3-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]propan-1-ol as an off-white solid, mp 157.0-160.0° C.
  • MS (APCI) m/z 318 (M+H)+;
  • Anal. calcd for C16H19N3O2S: C, 60.55; H, 6.03; N, 13.24. Found C, 60.32; H, 5.97; N, 13.33.
  • Examples 108-127 Part A
  • A solution of 4-hydroxypiperidine (10.00 g, 98.86 mmol), triethylamine (27.55 mL, 197.7 mmol), and dichloromethane (100 mL) was cooled to approximately 0° C. under a nitrogen atmosphere. Di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (23.73 g, 108.7 mmol) was added over a period of five minutes. The reaction was allowed to warm to room temperature slowly and stirred overnight and then added slowly with vigorous stirring to a cold (0° C.) solution of acetic acid (50 mL of 15% w/w in water). The organic layer was separated and washed sequentially with 15% w/w acetic acid in water (50 mL) and saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate (3×33 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide tert-butyl 4-hydroxypiperidine-1-carboxylate as a golden oil that slowly solidified to an off-white solid.
  • Part B
  • A solution of diisopropyldiazodicarboxylate (4.63 mL, 23.5 mmol) was added dropwise over a period of two minutes to a solution of 2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-ol (prepared as described in Parts A through C of Example 4, 5.00 g, 20.5 mmol), tert-butyl 4-hydroxypiperidine-1-carboxylate (4.74 g, 23.5 mmol), and triphenylphosphine (6.16 g, 23.5 mmol) in tetrahydrofuran (150 mL) at 0° C. The resulting solution was allowed to warm to room temperature and stirred for 15 hours. A precipitate was present and was removed by filtration. The filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 5% CMA in chloroform). The resulting oil was treated with boiling tert-butyl methyl ether, and a precipitate formed. The precipitate was removed by filtration, and the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure. The residue was recrystallized from methanol to provide 3.76 g tert-butyl 4-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate as a white solid. The mother liquor was concentrated under reduced pressure to provide an additional 6.24 g of product containing some triphenylphosphine oxide.
  • Part C
  • mCPBA (1.97 g of 70% pure material, 11 mmol) was added to a solution of tert-butyl 4-[(2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate (3.76 g, 8.79 mmol), and the reaction was stirred at room temperature for 1.5 hours. An analysis by LC/MS indicated the presence of starting material, and additional mCPBA (250 mg) was added. The reaction was stirred at room temperature for an additional 1.5 hours; diluted with chloroform (20 mL); washed sequentially with aqueous sodium carbonate (20 mL of 10% w/w), water (20 mL), and brine (20 mL); dried over sodium sulfate; filtered; and concentrated under reduced pressure to provide tert-butyl 4-[(5-oxido-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate as a light yellow solid.
  • Part D
  • A solution of the material from Part C in 1,2-dichloroethane (60 mL) was heated to 65° C. in a pressure vessel. Aqueous ammonium hydroxide (20 mL of 30% w/w) and p-toluenesulfonyl chloride (1.76 g, 9.23 mmol) were quickly added, and the vessel was sealed and heated at 70° C. for 15 hours and allowed to cool to room temperature. The organic layer was separated and washed sequentially with aqueous sodium carbonate (20 mL of 10% w/w) and water (20 mL). The combined aqueous fractions were extracted with chloroform (20 mL). The combined organic fractions were washed with brine (25 mL), dried over sodium sulfate, filtered, and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude product was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0% to 10% CMA in chloroform) to provide 2.07 g of tert-butyl 4-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate as a yellow solid.
  • Part E
  • A solution of hydrogen chloride (8 mL of 3.0 M in ethanol) was added to a solution of tert-butyl 4-[(4-amino-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-7-yl)oxy]piperidine-1-carboxylate (2.07 g, 4.68 mmol) in ethanol (16 mL), and the resulting solution was heated at 100° C. for 30 minutes. A precipitate formed, and the mixture was allowed to cool to room temperature and diluted with diethyl ether (25 mL). The precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with diethyl ether, and dried under vacuum overnight. The solid was suspended in a small volume of water, and the suspension was cooled to approximately 0° C. and adjusted to approximately pH 10 with the addition of 50% w/w aqueous sodium hydroxide. A yellow precipitate formed and was collected by filtration, washed with water, and dried overnight under vacuum. The solid was purified by column chromatography using a HORIZON HPFC system (silica cartridge, eluting with 0% to 15% CMA in chloroform) followed by recrystallization from acetonitrile. The crystals were dried to provide 7-(piperidin-4-yloxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine as yellow crystals.
  • 1H NMR (300 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.65 (d, J=8.7 Hz, 1H), 7.03 (d, J=2.4 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8.7, 2.4 Hz, 1H), 6.77 (s, 2H), 4.54-4.46 (m, 1H), 3.12 (t, J=7.3 Hz, 2H), 2.99-2.92 (m, 2H), 2.64-2.55 (m, 2H), 1.99-1.93 (m, 3H), 1.85 (q, J=7.4 Hz, 2H), 1.54-1.42 (m, 2H), 1.01 (t, J=7.3 Hz, 3H); MS (APCI) m/z 343.16 (M+H)+.
  • Part F
  • A reagent from the table below (1.1 equivalents, 0.11 mmol) was added to a test tube containing a solution of 7-(piperidin-4-yloxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (34 mg, 0.10 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (35 μL, 0.20 mmol) in DMA (1 mL). Each test tube was capped and vortexed overnight. Water (100 μL) was added to each test tube, and then the solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by prep HPLC according to the method described in Examples 17-55. The table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, or isocyanate used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Examples 108-127
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00206
    Measured
    Mass
    Example Reagent R (M + H)
    108 None
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00207
    343.1575
    109 Acetyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00208
    385.1675
    110 Propionyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00209
    399.1830
    111 Cyclopropanecarbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00210
    411.1852
    112 Butyryl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00211
    413.1994
    113 Isobutyryl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00212
    413.1981
    114 Cyclopentanecarbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00213
    439.2160
    115 Cyclohexanecarbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00214
    453.2302
    116 Ethanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00215
    435.1503
    117 1-Propanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00216
    449.1667
    118 Isopropylsulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00217
    449.1693
    119 1-Butanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00218
    463.1841
    120 Methyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00219
    400.1782
    121 Ethyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00220
    414.1935
    122 Isopropyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00221
    428.2093
    123 n-Propyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00222
    428.2105
    124 Cyclopropylisothiocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00223
    442.1723
    125 Cyclopentylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00224
    454.2264
    126 Cyclohexyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00225
    468.2426
    127 4-Morpholinylcarbonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00226
    456.2072
  • Examples 128-148
  • A reagent from the table below (1.1 equivalents, 0.11 mmol) was added to a test tube containing a solution of 7-(2-aminoethoxy)-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine hydrochloride, prepared as described in Example 13, Part A, (33.3 mg, 0.10 mmol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (85 μL, 0.49 mmol) in DMA (1 mL). Each test tube was capped and vortexed overnight. Water (two drops) was added to each test tube, and then the solvent was removed by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified by prep HPLC according to the method described in Examples 17-55. The table below shows the acid chloride, sulfonyl chloride, or isocyanate used for each example, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Examples 128-148
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00227
    Measured
    Mass
    Example Reagent R (M + H)
    128 None
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00228
    303.1298
    129 Cyclopropane-carbonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00229
    371.1510
    130 Isobutyrylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00230
    373.1663
    131 Cyclopentane-carbonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00231
    399.1880
    132 Benzoyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00232
    407.1519
    133 Isonicotinoylchloridehydrochloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00233
    408.1518
    134 Nicotinoyl chloridehydrochloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00234
    408.1521
    135 Methanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00235
    381.1058
    136 Ethanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00236
    395.1172
    137 Dimethylsulfamoylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00237
    410.1331
    138 Benzenesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00238
    443.1214
    139 1-Methylimidazole-4-sulfonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00239
    447.1289
    140 2,2,2-Trifluoro-ethanesulfonylchloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00240
    449.0932
    141 n-Propyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00241
    388.1840
    142 Cyclopentylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00242
    414.1980
    143 Phenyl isocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00243
    422.1646
    144 Cyclohexylisocyanate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00244
    428.2161
    145 N,N-Dimethyl-carbamoyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00245
    374.1687
    146 1-Pyrrolidine-carbonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00246
    400.1770
    147 1-Piperidine-carbonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00247
    414.1926
    148 4-Morpholinyl-carbonyl chloride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00248
    416.1797
  • Examples 149-189
  • A phenol (0.165 mmol, 1.5 equivalents) from the table below was added to a test tube containing 7-[2-(2-chloroethoxy)ethoxy]-2-propyl[1,3]thiazolo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine (prepared as described in Example 16, 40.3 mg, 0.11 mmol) and potassium carbonate (55 mg, 0.40 mmol) in DMA (1 mL). Each tube was capped and heated at 85° C. overnight. Each reaction mixture was filtered, and the filter cake was washed with DMA (0.200 mL). The solvent was then removed from the filtrate by vacuum centrifugation. The compounds were purified using the method described in Examples 17-55. The table below shows the phenol added to each test tube, the structure of the resulting compound, and the observed accurate mass for the isolated trifluoroacetate salt.
  • Examples 149-189
  • Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00249
    Measured
    Mass
    Example Reagent R (M + H)
     16 None
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00250
    366.1035
    149 Phenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00251
    424.1713
    150 m-Cresol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00252
    438.1844
    151 o-Cresol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00253
    438.1863
    152 p-Cresol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00254
    438.1847
    153 2-Fluorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00255
    442.1598
    154 3-Fluorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00256
    442.1601
    155 4-Fluorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00257
    442.1590
    156 2-Cyanophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00258
    449.1609
    157 3-Cyanophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00259
    449.1630
    158 4-Cyanophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00260
    449.1649
    159 2,3-Dimethylphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00261
    452.2024
    160 2,4-Dimethylphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00262
    452.2026
    161 2,5-Dimethylphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00263
    452.1971
    162 3,4-Dimethylphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00264
    452.1993
    163 3-Methoxyphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00265
    454.1823
    164 4-Methoxyphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00266
    454.1813
    165 2-Chlorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00267
    458.1309
    166 3-Chlorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00268
    458.1305
    167 4-Chlorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00269
    458.1325
    168 4′-Hydroxy-acetophenone
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00270
    466.1804
    169 3′-Hydroxy-acetophenone
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00271
    466.1821
    170 4-Hydroxy-benzamide
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00272
    467.1742
    171 Salicylamide
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00273
    467.1720
    172 2-Nitrophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00274
    469.1570
    173 3-Nitrophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00275
    469.1559
    174 4-Nitrophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00276
    469.1566
    175 (2-Hydroxy)thioanisole
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00277
    470.1526
    176 4-(Methylmercapto)phenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00278
    470.1615
    177 3-tert-Butyl-phenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00279
    480.2295
    178 2-Acetamidophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00280
    481.1928
    179 3-Acetamidophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00281
    481.1924
    180 4-Acetamidophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00282
    481.1940
    181 Methyl 3-hydroxybenzoate
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00283
    482.1783
    182 2-Isopropoxyphenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00284
    482.2131
    183 2-Hydroxybenzo-trifluoride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00285
    492.1588
    184 3-Hydroxybenzo-trifluoride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00286
    492.1577
    185 4-Hydroxybenzo-trifluoride
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00287
    492.1598
    186 2,3-Dichlorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00288
    492.0910
    187 2,4-Dichlorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00289
    492.0929
    188 2,5-Dichlorophenol
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00290
    492.0930
    189 4-Hydroxybenzene-sulfonamide
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00291
    503.1436
  • Exemplary Compounds
  • Certain exemplary compounds, including some of those described above in the Examples, have the following Formula (IId) and the following Z, R3d, and R2, substituents, wherein each line of the table is matched with Formula IId to represent a specific embodiment of the invention.
  • IId
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00292
    Z R3d R2
    —CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxethyl)piperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (methyl sulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1 -yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxethyl)piperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxethyl)piperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxethyl)piperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-l -yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxethyl)piperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (methylsulfonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 pyrrolidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 morpholin-4-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 piperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 azepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 azepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 azepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 azepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-ethylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-acetylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxethyl)piperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-(2-hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 3,4-dihydroisoquinolin-2(1H)-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-methyl-1,4-diazepan-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrimidin-2-ylpiperazin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
  • Certain exemplary compounds, including some of those described above in the Examples, have the following Formula (IIe) and the following Z, R3e, and R2, substituents, wherein each line of the table is matched with Formula IIe to represent a specific embodiment of the invention.
  • IIe
    Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00293
    Z R3e R2
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- propyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- butyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- 2-methoxyethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethoxymethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- propyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- butyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- 2-methoxyethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethoxymethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- propyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- butyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- 2-methoxyethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethoxymethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- propyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- butyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- 2-methoxyethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethoxymethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- propyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- butyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- 2-methoxyethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethoxymethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- propyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- butyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- 2-methoxyethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethoxymethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- propyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- butyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- 2-methoxyethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethoxymethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- propyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- butyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- 2-methoxyethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethoxymethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- propyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- butyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- 2-methoxyethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethoxymethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- propyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- butyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- 2-methoxyethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethoxymethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 (phenylaminocarbonothioyl)amino ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- propyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- butyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- 2-methoxyethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 {[(3-methoxyphenyl)amino]- ethoxymethyl
    carbonyl}amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- propyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- butyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- 2-methoxyethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 methyl(1-methylpiperdin-4- ethoxymethyl
    yl)amino
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 4-pyrrolidin-1-ylpiperidin-1-yl ethoxymethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl propyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl butyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl 2-methoxyethyl
    —CH2CH2OCH2CH2 1,4′-bipiperidin-1′-yl ethoxymethyl
  • Compounds of the invention have been found to modulate cytokine biosynthesis by inducing the production of interferon α and/or tumor necrosis factor a in human cells when tested using one of the methods described below.
  • Cytokine Induction in Human Cells
  • An in vitro human blood cell system is used to assess cytokine induction. Activity is based on the measurement of interferon (α) and tumor necrosis factor (α) (IFN-α and TNF-α, respectively) secreted into culture media as described by Testerman et. al. in “Cytokine Induction by the Immunomodulators Imiquimod and S-27609”, Journal of Leukocyte Biology, 58, 365-372 (September, 1995).
  • Blood Cell Preparation for Culture
  • Whole blood from healthy human donors is collected by venipuncture into vacutainer tubes or syringes containing EDTA. Peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) are separated from whole blood by density gradient centrifugation using HISTOPAQUE-1077 (Sigma, St. Louis, Mo.) or Ficoll-Paque Plus (Amersham Biosciences Piscataway, N.J.). Blood is diluted 1:1 with Dulbecco's Phosphate Buffered Saline (DPBS) or Hank's Balanced Salts Solution (HBSS). Alternately, whole blood is placed in Accuspin (Sigma) or LeucoSep (Greiner Bio-One, Inc., Longwood, Fla.) centrifuge frit tubes containing density gradient medium. The PBMC layer is collected and washed twice with DPBS or HBSS and re-suspended at 4×106 cells/mL in RPMI complete. The PBMC suspension is added to 96 well flat bottom sterile tissue culture plates containing an equal volume of RPMI complete media containing test compound.
  • Compound Preparation
  • The compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO). The DMSO concentration should not exceed a final concentration of 1% for addition to the culture wells. The compounds are generally tested at concentrations ranging from 30-0.014 μM. Controls include cell samples with media only, cell samples with DMSO only (no compound), and cell samples with reference compound.
  • Incubation
  • The solution of test compound is added at 60 μM to the first well containing RPMI complete and serial 3 fold dilutions are made in the wells. The PBMC suspension is then added to the wells in an equal volume, bringing the test compound concentrations to the desired range (usually 30-0.014 μM). The final concentration of PBMC suspension is 2×106 cells/mL. The plates are covered with sterile plastic lids, mixed gently and then incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37° C. in a 5% carbon dioxide atmosphere.
  • Separation
  • Following incubation the plates are centrifuged for 10 minutes at 1000 rpm (approximately 200×g) at 4° C. The cell-free culture supernatant is removed and transferred to sterile polypropylene tubes. Samples are maintained at −30 to −70° C. until analysis. The samples are analyzed for IFN-α by ELISA and for TNF-α by IGEN/BioVeris Assay.
  • Interferon (α) and Tumor Necrosis Factor (α) Analysis
  • IFN-α concentration is determined with a human multi-subtype colorimetric sandwich ELISA (Catalog Number 41105) from PBL Biomedical Laboratories, Piscataway, N.J. Results are expressed in pg/mL.
  • The TNF-α concentration is determined by ORIGEN M-Series Immunoassay and read on an IGEN M-8 analyzer from BioVeris Corporation, formerly known as IGEN
  • International, Gaithersburg, Md. The immunoassay uses a human TNF-α capture and detection antibody pair (Catalog Numbers AHC3419 and AHC3712) from Biosource International, Camarillo, Calif. Results are expressed in pg/mL.
  • Assay Data and Analysis
  • In total, the data output of the assay consists of concentration values of TNF-α and IFN-α (y-axis) as a function of compound concentration (x-axis).
  • Analysis of the data has two steps. First, the greater of the mean DMSO (DMSO control wells) or the experimental background (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN-α and 40 pg/mL for TNF-α) is subtracted from each reading. If any negative values result from background subtraction, the reading is reported as “*”, and is noted as not reliably detectable. In subsequent calculations and statistics, “*”, is treated as a zero. Second, all background subtracted values are multiplied by a single adjustment ratio to decrease experiment to experiment variability. The adjustment ratio is the area of the reference compound in the new experiment divided by the expected area of the reference compound based on the past 61 experiments (unadjusted readings). This results in the scaling of the reading (y-axis) for the new data without changing the shape of the dose-response curve. The reference compound used is 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-α,α-dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91) and the expected area is the sum of the median dose values from the past 61 experiments.
  • The minimum effective concentration is calculated based on the background-subtracted, reference-adjusted results for a given experiment and compound. The minimum effective concentration (μmolar) is the lowest of the tested compound concentrations that induces a response over a fixed cytokine concentration for the tested cytokine (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN-α and 40 pg/mL for TNF-α). The maximal response is the maximal amount of cytokine (pg/ml) produced in the dose-response.
  • Cytokine Induction in Human Cells High Throughput Screen
  • The CYTOKINE INDUCTION IN HUMAN CELLS test method described above was modified as follows for high throughput screening.
  • Blood Cell Preparation for Culture
  • Whole blood from healthy human donors is collected by venipuncture into vacutainer tubes or syringes containing EDTA. Peripheral blood mononuclear cells (PBMC) are separated from whole blood by density gradient centrifugation using HISTOPAQUE-1077 (Sigma, St. Louis, Mo.) or Ficoll-Paque Plus (Amersham Biosciences Piscataway, N.J.). Whole blood is placed in Accuspin (Sigma) or LeucoSep (Greiner Bio-One, Inc., Longwood, Fla.) centrifuge frit tubes containing density gradient medium. The PBMC layer is collected and washed twice with DPBS or HBSS and re-suspended at 4×106 cells/mL in RPMI complete (2-fold the final cell density). The PBMC suspension is added to 96-well flat bottom sterile tissue culture plates.
  • Compound Preparation
  • The compounds are solubilized in dimethyl sulfoxide (DMSO). The compounds are generally tested at concentrations ranging from 30-0.014 μM. Controls include cell samples with media only, cell samples with DMSO only (no compound), and cell samples with a reference compound 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-α,α-dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91) on each plate. The solution of test compound is added at 7.5 mM to the first well of a dosing plate and serial 3 fold dilutions are made for the 7 subsequent concentrations in DMSO. RPMI Complete media is then added to the test compound dilutions in order to reach a final compound concentration of 2-fold higher (60-0.028 μM) than the final tested concentration range.
  • Incubation
  • Compound solution is then added to the wells containing the PBMC suspension bringing the test compound concentrations to the desired range (usually 30-0.014 μM) and the DMSO concentration to 0.4%. The final concentration of PBMC suspension is 2×106 cells/mL. The plates are covered with sterile plastic lids, mixed gently and then incubated for 18 to 24 hours at 37° C. in a 5% carbon dioxide atmosphere.
  • Separation
  • Following incubation the plates are centrifuged for 10 minutes at 1000 rpm (approximately 200 g) at 4° C. 4-plex Human Panel MSD MULTI-SPOT 96-well plates are pre-coated with the appropriate capture antibodies by MesoScale Discovery, Inc. (MSD, Gaithersburg, Md.). The cell-free culture supernatants are removed and transferred to the MSD plates. Fresh samples are typically tested, although they may be maintained at −30 to −70° C. until analysis.
  • Interferon-α and Tumor Necrosis Factor-α Analysis
  • MSD MULTI-SPOT plates contain within each well capture antibodies for human TNF-α and human IFN-α that have been pre-coated on specific spots. Each well contains four spots: one human TNF-α capture antibody (MSD) spot, one human IFN-α capture antibody (PBL Biomedical Laboratories, Piscataway, N.J.) spot, and two inactive bovine serum albumin spots. The human TNF-α capture and detection antibody pair is from MesoScale Discovery. The human IFN-α multi-subtype antibody (PBL Biomedical Laboratories) captures all IFN-α subtypes except IFN-α F (IFNα21). Standards consist of recombinant human TNF-α (R&D Systems, Minneapolis, Minn.) and IFN-α (PBL Biomedical Laboratories). Samples and separate standards are added at the time of analysis to each MSD plate. Two human IFN-α detection antibodies (Cat. Nos. 21112 & 21100, PBL) are used in a two to one ratio (weight:weight) to each other to determine the IFN-α concentrations. The cytokine-specific detection antibodies are labeled with the SULFO-TAG reagent (MSD). After adding the SULFO-TAG labeled detection antibodies to the wells, each well's electrochemoluminescent levels are read using MSD's SECTOR HTS READER. Results are expressed in pg/mL upon calculation with known cytokine standards.
  • Assay Data and Analysis
  • In total, the data output of the assay consists of concentration values of TNF-α or IFN-α (y-axis) as a function of compound concentration (x-axis).
  • A plate-wise scaling is performed within a given experiment aimed at reducing plate-to-plate variability associated within the same experiment. First, the greater of the median DMSO (DMSO control wells) or the experimental background (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN-α and 40 pg/mL for TNF-α) is subtracted from each reading. Negative values that may result from background subtraction are set to zero. Each plate within a given experiment has a reference compound that serves as a control. This control is used to calculate a median expected area under the curve across all plates in the assay. A plate-wise scaling factor is calculated for each plate as a ratio of the area of the reference compound on the particular plate to the median expected area for the entire experiment. The data from each plate are then multiplied by the plate-wise scaling factor for all plates. Only data from plates bearing a scaling factor of between 0.5 and 2.0 (for both cytokines IFN-α, TNF-α) are reported. Data from plates with scaling factors outside the above mentioned interval are retested until they bear scaling factors inside the above mentioned interval. The above method produces a scaling of the y-values without altering the shape of the curve. The reference compound used is 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-α,α-dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91). The median expected area is the median area across all plates that are part of a given experiment.
  • A second scaling may also be performed to reduce inter-experiment variability (across multiple experiments). All background-subtracted values are multiplied by a single adjustment ratio to decrease experiment-to-experiment variability. The adjustment ratio is the area of the reference compound in the new experiment divided by the expected area of the reference compound based on an average of previous experiments (unadjusted readings). This results in the scaling of the reading (y-axis) for the new data without changing the shape of the dose-response curve. The reference compound used is 2-[4-amino-2-ethoxymethyl-6,7,8,9-tetrahydro-α,α-dimethyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl]ethanol hydrate (U.S. Pat. No. 5,352,784; Example 91) and the expected area is the sum of the median dose values from an average of previous experiments.
  • The minimum effective concentration is calculated based on the background-subtracted, reference-adjusted results for a given experiment and compound. The minimum effective concentration (μmolar) is the lowest of the tested compound concentrations that induces a response over a fixed cytokine concentration for the tested cytokine (usually 20 pg/mL for IFN-α and 40 pg/mL for TNF-α). The maximal response is the maximal amount of cytokine (pg/ml) produced in the dose-response.
  • The complete disclosures of the patents, patent documents, and publications cited herein are incorporated by reference in their entirety as if each were individually incorporated. Various modifications and alterations to this invention will become apparent to those skilled in the art without departing from the scope and spirit of this invention. It should be understood that this invention is not intended to be unduly limited by the illustrative embodiments and examples set forth herein and that such examples and embodiments are presented by way of example only with the scope of the invention intended to be limited only by the claims set forth herein as follows.

Claims (28)

1. A compound of Formula I:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00294
wherein:
RA and RB taken together form a fused benzene ring or fused pyridine ring wherein the benzene ring or pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group, or substituted by one —O—R3 group and one R group;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
-Z-Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-R5,
-Z-Het,
-Z-Het′-R4, and
-Z-Het′-Y—R4;
R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
R″ is hydrogen or a non-interfering substituent;
Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
—O—N(R8)-Q-,
—O—N═C(R4)—,
—C(═N—O—R8)—,
—CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00295
Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00296
R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00297
wherein V is —C(R6)— or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00298
R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00299
wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00300
and
with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
2. The compound or salt of claim 1 wherein R″ is R2; wherein R2 is selected from the group consisting of —R4, —X—R4, —X—Y′—R4, and —X—R5′; wherein
Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
—O—,
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00301
R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00302
3. A compound of Formula VII:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00303
wherein:
RA and RB taken together form a fused benzene ring or fused pyridine ring wherein the benzene ring or pyridine ring is substituted by one —O—R3 group, or substituted by one —O—R3 group and one R group;
R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
-Z-Y—R4,
Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-R5,
-Z-Het,
-Z-Het′-R4, and
-Z-Het′-Y—R4;
R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
G is selected from the group consisting of:
—C(O)—R′,
α-aminoacyl,
α-aminoacyl-α-aminoacyl,
—C(O)—O—R′,
—C(O)—N(R′″)R′,
—C(═NY1)—R′,
—CH(OH)—C(O)—OY1,
—CH(OC1-4 alkyl)Y0,
—CH2Y2, and
—CH(CH3)Y2;
R′ and R′″ are independently selected from the group consisting of C10 alkyl, C3-7 cycloalkyl, phenyl, and benzyl, each of which may be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of halogen, hydroxy, nitro, cyano, carboxy, C1-6 alkyl, C1-4 alkoxy, aryl, heteroaryl, aryl-C1-4 alkylenyl, heteroaryl-C1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C1-4 alkylenyl, halo-C1-4 alkoxy, —O—C(O)—CH3, —C(O)—O—CH3, —C(O)—NH2, —O—CH2—C(O)—NH2, —NH2, and —S(O)2—NH2, with the proviso that R′″ can also be hydrogen;
α-aminoacyl is an α-aminoacyl group derived from an amino acid selected from the group consisting of racemic, D-, and L-amino acids;
Y1 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-6 alkyl, and benzyl;
Y0 is selected from the group consisting of C1-6 alkyl, carboxy-C1-6 alkylenyl, amino-C1-4 alkylenyl, mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino-C1-4alkylenyl, and di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino-C1-4 alkylenyl;
Y2 is selected from the group consisting of mono-N—C1-6 alkylamino, di-N,N—C1-6 alkylamino, morpholin-4-yl, piperidin-1-yl, pyrrolidin-1-yl, and 4-C1-4 alkylpiperazin-1-yl;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
—R4,
—X—R4,
—X—Y′—R4, and
—X—R5′;
Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
—O—N(R8)-Q-,
—O—N═C(R4)—,
—C(═N—O—R8)—,
—CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00304
Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
—O—,
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00305
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00306
R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00307
R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8),
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00308
 wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00309
R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00310
 wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00311
and
with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
4. (canceled)
5. A compound of claim 1, wherein Formula I is Formula II:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00312
wherein:
R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
-Z-Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-R5,
-Z-Het,
-Z-Het′-R4, and
-Z-Het′-Y—R4;
R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
n is 0 or 1;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
—R4,
—X—R4,
—X—Y′—R4, and
—X—R5′;
Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
—O—N(R8)-Q-,
—O—N═C(R4)—,
—C(═N—O—R8)—,
—CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00313
Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
—O—,
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00314
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00315
R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00316
R5′ is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
V is selected from the group consisting of —C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00317
 wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00318
 or
R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00319
 wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00320
 and
with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
6. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein n is 0.
7-8. (canceled)
9. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein
R3 is -Z-Y—R4 or
-Z-Y—X—Y—R4.
10. The compound or salt of claim 9 wherein Y is —N(R8)-Q-,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00321
or —C(O)—; wherein
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, —C(O)—O—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—, and —S(O)2—N(R8)—;
R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O or —S;
R7 is C2-3 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, C1-4 alkyl, and C1-4 alkoxyC1-4 alkylenyl;
R10 is C3-6 alkylene; and
R4 is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryl, and heterocyclyl;
wherein alkyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of hydroxy, alkoxy, halogen, and aryl;
wherein aryl, heteroaryl, and arylalkylenyl are unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, dialkylamino, and alkoxy;
and wherein heterocyclyl is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more alkyl substituents.
11-18. (canceled)
19. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein:
R3 is -Z-Y—R4, wherein Y is —O— and R4 is phenyl that is unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents selected from the group consisting of alkyl, halogen, cyano, alkoxy, nitro, and haloalkyl; or
R3 is -Z-Y—X—Yc—R4, wherein Y is —O—, X is phenylene, and Yc—R4 is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—O-alkyl, —S-alkyl, —NH—C(O)-alkyl, —C(O)—NH2, and —S(O)2—NH2.
20. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein R3 is -Z-R5.
21-22. (canceled)
23. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein R3 is -Z-Het or -Z-Het′-R4.
24-27. (canceled)
28. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein R3 is -Z-Het′-Y—R4.
29-30. (canceled)
31. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein Z is alkylene optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups.
32. (canceled)
33. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein Z is a bond.
34. The compound or salt of claim 5 wherein —O—R3 is at the 7-position.
35. A compound of the Formula X:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00322
wherein:
R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
n is 0 or 1;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
—R4,
—X—R4,
—X—Y′—R4, and
—X—R5′;
Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
—O—,
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00323
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00324
R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
36. (canceled)
37. A pharmaceutical composition comprising a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of claim 1 and a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.
38. A method of inducing cytokine biosynthesis in an animal comprising administering an effective amount of a compound or salt of claim 1 to the animal.
39. A method of treating a viral disease in an animal in need thereof comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of claim 1.
40. A method of treating a neoplastic disease in an animal in need thereof comprising administering a therapeutically effective amount of a compound or salt of claim 1.
41. A compound of the Formula XII:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00325
wherein:
R3 is selected from the group consisting of:
-Z-Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4,
-Z-R5,
-Z-Het,
-Z-Het′-R4, and
-Z-Het′-Y—R4;
R is selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxy, halogen, and trifluoromethyl;
n is 0 or 1;
R2 is selected from the group consisting of:
—R4,
—X—R4,
—X—Y′—R4, and
—X—R5′;
Z is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene, wherein alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene can be optionally interrupted with one or more —O— groups;
Y is selected from the group consisting of:
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
—O—N(R8)-Q-,
—O—N═C(R4)—,
—C(═N—O—R8)—,
—CH(—N(—O—R8)-Q-R4)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00326
Het is heterocyclyl which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, hydroxyalkyleneoxyalkylenyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
Het′ is heterocyclylene which can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, hydroxyalkyl, cyano, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, and oxo;
X is selected from the group consisting of alkylene, alkenylene, alkynylene, arylene, heteroarylene, and heterocyclylene wherein the alkylene, alkenylene, and alkynylene groups can be optionally interrupted or terminated with arylene, heteroarylene, or heterocyclylene, and optionally interrupted by one or more —O— groups;
Y′ is selected from the group consisting of:
—O—,
—S(O)0-2—,
—S(O)2—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—,
—C(R6)—O—,
—O—C(R6)—,
—O—C(O)—O—,
—N(R8)-Q-,
—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—O—C(R6)—N(R8)—,
—C(R6)—N(OR9)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00327
R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl wherein the alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, aryl, arylalkylenyl, aryloxyalkylenyl, alkylarylenyl, heteroaryl, heteroarylalkylenyl, heteroaryloxyalkylenyl, alkylheteroarylenyl, and heterocyclyl groups can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents independently selected from the group consisting of alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyalkyl, haloalkyl, haloalkoxy, halogen, nitro, hydroxy, mercapto, cyano, aryl, aryloxy, arylalkyleneoxy, heteroaryl, heteroaryloxy, heteroarylalkyleneoxy, heterocyclyl, amino, alkylamino, dialkylamino, (dialkylamino)alkyleneoxy, and in the case of alkyl, alkenyl, alkynyl, and heterocyclyl, oxo;
R5 is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00328
R5′ is selected from the group consisting of:
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00329
R6 is selected from the group consisting of ═O and ═S;
R7 is C2-7 alkylene;
R8 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, alkyl, hydroxyalkylenyl, alkoxyalkylenyl, arylalkylenyl, and heteroarylalkylenyl;
R9 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen and alkyl;
R10 is C3-8 alkylene;
A is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —CH2—, —C(O)—, —S(O)0-2—, and —N(R4)—;
A′ is selected from the group consisting of —O—, —S(O)0-2—, —N(-Q-R4)—, and —CH2—;
Q is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—C(R6)—, —S(O)2—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—W—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—O—, and —C(R6)—N(OR9)—;
V is selected from the group consisting of-C(R6)—, —O—C(R6)—, —N(R8)—C(R6)—, and —S(O)2—;
W is selected from the group consisting of a bond, —C(O)—, and —S(O)2—; and
a and b are independently integers from 1 to 6 with the proviso that a+b is ≦7;
with the proviso that Z can also be a bond when:
R3 is -Z-Het, -Z-Het′-R4, or -Z-Het′-Y—R4, and Z is attached to an atom other than N in Het or Het′; or
R3 is -Z-Y—R4, -Z-Y—X—Y—R4, or -Z-Y—X—Y—X—Y—R4, and the Y group bonded to Z is —S(O)2—, —S(O)2—N(R8)—, —C(R6)—, —C(R6)—O—, —C(R6)—N(R8)—,
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00330
 wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00331
 or
R3 is -Z-R5, and R5 is
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00332
 wherein V is —C(R6)— or —S(O)2—, or
Figure US20080318998A1-20081225-C00333
 and
with the further proviso that Y can also be —O— when:
Y is bonded to R4, and R4 is selected from the group consisting of hydrogen, aryl, and heteroaryl, wherein aryl and heteroaryl can be unsubstituted or substituted by one or more substituents; or
Y is bonded to Z and X, and X is arylene or heteroarylene;
or a pharmaceutically acceptable salt thereof.
US11/884,052 2005-02-09 2006-02-08 Alkyloxy Substituted Thiazoloquinolines and Thiazolonaphthyridines Abandoned US20080318998A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US11/884,052 US20080318998A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-02-08 Alkyloxy Substituted Thiazoloquinolines and Thiazolonaphthyridines

Applications Claiming Priority (4)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US65158505P 2005-02-09 2005-02-09
US73303605P 2005-11-03 2005-11-03
PCT/US2006/004391 WO2006086449A2 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-02-08 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US11/884,052 US20080318998A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-02-08 Alkyloxy Substituted Thiazoloquinolines and Thiazolonaphthyridines

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
PCT/US2006/004391 A-371-Of-International WO2006086449A2 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-02-08 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/732,815 Continuation US9546184B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2015-06-08 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20080318998A1 true US20080318998A1 (en) 2008-12-25

Family

ID=36793669

Family Applications (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/884,052 Abandoned US20080318998A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2006-02-08 Alkyloxy Substituted Thiazoloquinolines and Thiazolonaphthyridines
US14/732,815 Expired - Fee Related US9546184B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2015-06-08 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US15/375,316 Abandoned US20170088559A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2016-12-12 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US15/801,448 Abandoned US20180057509A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2017-11-02 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines

Family Applications After (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/732,815 Expired - Fee Related US9546184B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2015-06-08 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US15/375,316 Abandoned US20170088559A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2016-12-12 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US15/801,448 Abandoned US20180057509A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2017-11-02 Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines

Country Status (7)

Country Link
US (4) US20080318998A1 (en)
EP (1) EP1846419B1 (en)
JP (1) JP5122980B2 (en)
AU (1) AU2006212765B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2597324C (en)
ES (1) ES2475728T3 (en)
WO (1) WO2006086449A2 (en)

Cited By (48)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7879849B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2011-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US7897597B2 (en) 2003-08-27 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US7897609B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
US7897767B2 (en) 2003-11-14 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US7906506B2 (en) 2006-07-12 2011-03-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US7915281B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Isoxazole, dihydroisoxazole, and oxadiazole substituted imidazo ring compounds and method
US7923429B2 (en) 2003-09-05 2011-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Treatment for CD5+ B cell lymphoma
US7943636B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-substituted pyrazolo (3,4-C) ring compounds as modulators of cytokine biosynthesis for the treatment of viral infections and neoplastic diseases
US7943610B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridine-1,4-diamines and analogs thereof
US7943609B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Proprerties Company Chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds
US7968563B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2011-06-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8017779B2 (en) 2004-06-15 2011-09-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Nitrogen containing heterocyclyl substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US8026366B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-09-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US8034938B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-10-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
US8088790B2 (en) 2005-11-04 2012-01-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazoquinolines and methods
US8158794B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2012-04-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinoline compounds and methods
US8178539B2 (en) 2006-09-06 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted 3,4,6,7-tetrahydro-5H-1,2a,4a,8-tetraazacyclopenta[cd]phenalenes and methods
US8178677B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US8188111B2 (en) 2005-09-09 2012-05-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide and carbamate derivatives of alkyl substituted N-[4-(4-amino-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl)butyI]methanesulfonamides and methods
US8329721B2 (en) 2006-03-15 2012-12-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazonaphthyridines and methods
US8378102B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2013-02-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted thiazolo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8476292B2 (en) 2005-09-09 2013-07-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide and carbamate derivatives of N-{2-[4-amino-2-(ethoxymethyl)-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-Yl]-1,1-dimethylethyl}methanesulfonamide and methods
US8541438B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2013-09-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US8598192B2 (en) 2003-11-14 2013-12-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxylamine substituted imidazoquinolines
US8658666B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2014-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US8673932B2 (en) 2003-08-12 2014-03-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazo-containing compounds
US8691837B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2014-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US8697873B2 (en) 2004-03-24 2014-04-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines, imidazoquinolines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US8735421B2 (en) 2003-12-30 2014-05-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
US8802853B2 (en) 2003-12-29 2014-08-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US8846710B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2014-09-30 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of preferentially inducing the biosynthesis of interferon
US8871782B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2014-10-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US8883174B2 (en) 2009-03-25 2014-11-11 The Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions for stimulation of mammalian innate immune resistance to pathogens
US20150072974A1 (en) * 2012-05-09 2015-03-12 Sunovion Pharmaceuticals Inc. Heteroaryl compounds and methods of use thereof
CN104761471A (en) * 2008-11-06 2015-07-08 日产化学工业株式会社 Liquid crystal aligning agent
US9107958B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2015-08-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydrazino 1H-imidazoquinolin-4-amines and conjugates made therefrom
US9145410B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2015-09-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US9242980B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2016-01-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US9248127B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2016-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
US9475804B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2016-10-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterobifunctional linkers with polyethylene glycol segments and immune response modifier conjugates made therefrom
US9546184B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2017-01-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US9801947B2 (en) 2003-04-10 2017-10-31 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods and compositions for enhancing immune response
US10286065B2 (en) 2014-09-19 2019-05-14 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions and methods for treating viral infections through stimulated innate immunity in combination with antiviral compounds
US10472420B2 (en) 2006-02-22 2019-11-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier conjugates
US10513515B2 (en) 2017-08-25 2019-12-24 Biotheryx, Inc. Ether compounds and uses thereof
US11236103B2 (en) 2018-07-27 2022-02-01 Biotheryx, Inc. Bifunctional compounds
US11306083B2 (en) 2017-12-20 2022-04-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazo[4,5-C]quinoline compounds with a branched chain linking group for use as an immune response modifier
US11897930B2 (en) 2020-04-28 2024-02-13 Anwita Biosciences, Inc. Interleukin-2 polypeptides and fusion proteins thereof, and their pharmaceutical compositions and therapeutic applications

Families Citing this family (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20080149123A1 (en) 2006-12-22 2008-06-26 Mckay William D Particulate material dispensing hairbrush with combination bristles
EP3756669A1 (en) 2013-01-07 2020-12-30 The Trustees of the University of Pennsylvania Compositions for use for treating cutaneous t cell lymphoma
WO2017059280A1 (en) 2015-10-02 2017-04-06 The University Of North Carolina At Chapel Hill Novel pan-tam inhibitors and mer/axl dual inhibitors
EP3558971B1 (en) 2016-12-22 2022-02-23 Global Blood Therapeutics, Inc. Histone methyltransferase inhibitors
PE20201342A1 (en) 2018-02-28 2020-11-25 Pfizer VARIANTS OF IL-15 AND USES OF THE SAME
BR112020022595A2 (en) 2018-05-23 2021-02-09 Pfizer Inc. specific antibodies to gucy2c and uses thereof
BR112020022897A2 (en) 2018-05-23 2021-02-23 Pfizer Inc. specific antibodies to cd3 and their uses
WO2020128893A1 (en) 2018-12-21 2020-06-25 Pfizer Inc. Combination treatments of cancer comprising a tlr agonist
CN115397853A (en) 2019-12-17 2022-11-25 辉瑞大药厂 Antibody with specificity to CD47 and PD-L1 and application thereof
CA3189590A1 (en) 2020-07-17 2022-01-20 Pfizer Inc. Therapeutic antibodies and their uses

Citations (77)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7301A (en) * 1850-04-23 Machine for drilling stone
US76828A (en) * 1868-04-14 Improvement in gas-heaters
US3314941A (en) * 1964-06-23 1967-04-18 American Cyanamid Co Novel substituted pyridodiazepins
US4902211A (en) * 1983-01-24 1990-02-20 Svanholm Engineering Ab Process and plant for manufacture of aerated concrete
US4988815A (en) * 1989-10-26 1991-01-29 Riker Laboratories, Inc. 3-Amino or 3-nitro quinoline compounds which are intermediates in preparing 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolines
US5389640A (en) * 1991-03-01 1995-02-14 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 1-substituted, 2-substituted 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
US5395937A (en) * 1993-01-29 1995-03-07 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for preparing quinoline amines
US5482936A (en) * 1995-01-12 1996-01-09 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-C]quinoline amines
US5494916A (en) * 1993-07-15 1996-02-27 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-C]pyridin-4-amines
US5714608A (en) * 1991-09-04 1998-02-03 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 1-substituted 1H-imidazo- 4,5-c!quinolin-4-amines
US5741908A (en) * 1996-06-21 1998-04-21 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for reparing imidazoquinolinamines
US5886006A (en) * 1993-07-15 1999-03-23 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Fused cycloalkylimidazopyridines
US6039969A (en) * 1996-10-25 2000-03-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier compounds for treatment of TH2 mediated and related diseases
US6194425B1 (en) * 1997-12-11 2001-02-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazonaphthyridines
US6365166B2 (en) * 1996-12-03 2002-04-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Gel formulations for topical drug delivery
US6376669B1 (en) * 1999-11-05 2002-04-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Dye labeled imidazoquinoline compounds
US6518265B1 (en) * 1998-08-12 2003-02-11 Hokuriku Seiyaku Co., Ltd. 1H-imidazopyridine derivatives
US6525064B1 (en) * 2000-12-08 2003-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido substituted imidazopyridines
US6541485B1 (en) * 1999-06-10 2003-04-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinolines
US6677347B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6677349B1 (en) * 2001-12-21 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamide and sulfamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6677348B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US20040014779A1 (en) * 2001-11-16 2004-01-22 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods and compositions related to IRM compounds and toll-like recptor pathways
US6683088B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6703402B2 (en) * 1998-07-28 2004-03-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxazolo, thiazolo and selenazolo [4,5-c]-quinolin-4-amines and analogs thereof
US6706728B2 (en) * 1999-01-08 2004-03-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Systems and methods for treating a mucosal surface
US6716988B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-04-06 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazopyridines
US6720333B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines
US6841678B2 (en) * 2002-07-26 2005-01-11 Biogal Gyogyszergyar Rt. Preparation of 1H-imidazo [4,5-C] quinolin-4-amines via novel 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] quinolin-4-cyano and 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] quinolin-4-carboxamide intermediates
US6852861B2 (en) * 2002-07-23 2005-02-08 Biogal Gyogyszergyar Rt. Preparation of 1H-imidazo [4,5-C] quinolin-4-amines via 1H-imidazo [4,5-C] quinolin-4-phthalimide intermediates
US20050048072A1 (en) * 2003-08-25 2005-03-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunostimulatory combinations and treatments
US20050059072A1 (en) * 2003-09-17 2005-03-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective modulation of TLR gene expression
US20050070460A1 (en) * 2003-08-05 2005-03-31 3M Innovative Properties Company Infection prophylaxis using immune response modifier compounds
US6894060B2 (en) * 2000-03-30 2005-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Method for the treatment of dermal lesions caused by envenomation
US20060045886A1 (en) * 2004-08-27 2006-03-02 Kedl Ross M HIV immunostimulatory compositions
US20060045885A1 (en) * 2004-08-27 2006-03-02 Kedl Ross M Method of eliciting an immune response against HIV
US20060051374A1 (en) * 2004-04-28 2006-03-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Compositions and methods for mucosal vaccination
US7030131B2 (en) * 1999-06-10 2006-04-18 Crooks Stephen L Sulfonamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US7030129B2 (en) * 2002-02-22 2006-04-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of reducing and treating UVB-induced immunosuppression
US20060088542A1 (en) * 2002-03-19 2006-04-27 Powdermed Limited Imidazoquinoline adjuvants for vaccines
US7157453B2 (en) * 1999-06-10 2007-01-02 3M Innovation Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinolines
US7163947B2 (en) * 2003-03-07 2007-01-16 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-Amino 1H-imidazoquinolines
US7179253B2 (en) * 2003-03-13 2007-02-20 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of tattoo removal
US20070060754A1 (en) * 2003-10-03 2007-03-15 Lindstrom Kyle J Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US20070066639A1 (en) * 2003-08-12 2007-03-22 Kshirsagar Tushar A Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US20070072893A1 (en) * 2003-11-25 2007-03-29 Krepski Larry R Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US20080015184A1 (en) * 2004-06-14 2008-01-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea Substituted Imidazopyridines, Imidazoquinolines, and Imidazonaphthyridines
US20080039533A1 (en) * 2003-07-31 2008-02-14 3M Innovative Properties Company Bioactive Compositions Comprising Triazines
US20080070907A1 (en) * 2006-07-12 2008-03-20 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-C] ring compounds and methods
US20080085895A1 (en) * 2004-12-30 2008-04-10 Griesgraber George W Substituted Chiral Fused [1,2]Imidazo[4,5-C] Ring Compounds
US20090005371A1 (en) * 2005-02-11 2009-01-01 Rice Michael J Substituted Fused [1,2]Imidazo[4,5-C] Ring Compounds and Methods
US20090017076A1 (en) * 2003-09-05 2009-01-15 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Treatment for cd5+ b cell lymphoma
US20090023722A1 (en) * 1999-06-10 2009-01-22 Coleman Patrick L Amide substituted imidazoquinolines
US20090023720A1 (en) * 2004-09-02 2009-01-22 Kshirsagar Tushar A 2-Amino 1H-Imidazo Ring Systems and Methods
US20090030030A1 (en) * 2003-12-29 2009-01-29 Bonk Jason D Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US20090030031A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2009-01-29 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Method of Preferentially Inducing the Biosynthesis of Interferon
US20090029988A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2009-01-29 Coley Pharmaceutical Grop, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl Substituted Imidazoquinolines
US7485432B2 (en) * 2003-02-27 2009-02-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective modulation of TLR-mediated biological activity
US20090035323A1 (en) * 2006-02-22 2009-02-05 Doris Stoermer Immune response modifier conjugates
US20090062328A1 (en) * 2005-02-11 2009-03-05 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Oxime and Hydroxylamine Substituted Imidazo[4,5-c] Ring Compounds and Methods
US20090062272A1 (en) * 2003-12-30 2009-03-05 Bonk Jason D Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
US20090069299A1 (en) * 2005-04-01 2009-03-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolo[3,4-c]Quinolines, Pyrazolo[3,4-c]Naphthyridines, Analogs Thereof, and Methods
US20090069314A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2009-03-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl Substituted Imidazoquinoline Compounds and Methods
US20090075980A1 (en) * 2003-10-03 2009-03-19 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolopyridines and Analogs Thereof
US20090099161A1 (en) * 2005-02-11 2009-04-16 Coley Pharmaceutial Group, Inc. Substituted Imidazoquinolines and Imidazonaphthyridines
US20090105295A1 (en) * 2003-11-14 2009-04-23 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxylamine substituted imidazoquinolines
US7655672B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2010-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier formulations containing oleic acid and methods
US20100028381A1 (en) * 2006-06-19 2010-02-04 3M Innovative Properties Company Formulation for delivery of immune response modifiers
US20100056557A1 (en) * 2004-12-30 2010-03-04 Bernd Benninghoff Treatment for cutaneous metastases
US7696159B2 (en) * 2003-03-25 2010-04-13 Graceway Pharmaceuticals, Llc Treatment for basal cell carcinoma
US7699057B2 (en) * 2003-03-13 2010-04-20 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for treating skin lesions
US20100096287A1 (en) * 2006-07-31 2010-04-22 Stoesz James D Immune Response Modifier Compositions and Methods
US7879849B2 (en) * 2003-10-03 2011-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US7884207B2 (en) * 2004-06-18 2011-02-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US7888349B2 (en) * 2003-12-29 2011-02-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Piperazine, [1,4]Diazepane, [1,4]Diazocane, and [1,5]Diazocane fused imidazo ring compounds
US7897767B2 (en) * 2003-11-14 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US7897609B2 (en) * 2004-06-18 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl substituted imidazonaphthyridines

Family Cites Families (119)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
IL73534A (en) 1983-11-18 1990-12-23 Riker Laboratories Inc 1h-imidazo(4,5-c)quinoline-4-amines,their preparation and pharmaceutical compositions containing certain such compounds
ZA848968B (en) 1983-11-18 1986-06-25 Riker Laboratories Inc 1h-imidazo(4,5-c)quinolines and 1h-imidazo(4,5-c)quinolin-4-amines
US5238944A (en) 1988-12-15 1993-08-24 Riker Laboratories, Inc. Topical formulations and transdermal delivery systems containing 1-isobutyl-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amine
US5756747A (en) 1989-02-27 1998-05-26 Riker Laboratories, Inc. 1H-imidazo 4,5-c!quinolin-4-amines
US5037986A (en) 1989-03-23 1991-08-06 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Olefinic 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
US4929624A (en) 1989-03-23 1990-05-29 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Olefinic 1H-imidazo(4,5-c)quinolin-4-amines
NZ232740A (en) 1989-04-20 1992-06-25 Riker Laboratories Inc Solution for parenteral administration comprising a 1h-imidazo(4,5-c) quinolin-4-amine derivative, an acid and a tonicity adjuster
DK0553202T3 (en) 1990-10-05 1995-07-03 Minnesota Mining & Mfg Process for the preparation of imidazo (4,5-c) quinoline-4-amines
US5175296A (en) 1991-03-01 1992-12-29 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines and processes for their preparation
US5266575A (en) 1991-11-06 1993-11-30 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 2-ethyl 1H-imidazo[4,5-ciquinolin-4-amines
IL105325A (en) 1992-04-16 1996-11-14 Minnesota Mining & Mfg Immunogen/vaccine adjuvant composition
US5352784A (en) 1993-07-15 1994-10-04 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Fused cycloalkylimidazopyridines
US5644063A (en) 1994-09-08 1997-07-01 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-c]pyridin-4-amine intermediates
JPH09208584A (en) 1996-01-29 1997-08-12 Terumo Corp Amide derivative, pharmaceutical preparation containing the same, and intermediate for synthesizing the same
US5693811A (en) 1996-06-21 1997-12-02 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for preparing tetrahdroimidazoquinolinamines
EP0894797A4 (en) 1997-01-09 2001-08-16 Terumo Corp Novel amide derivatives and intermediates for the synthesis thereof
JPH1180156A (en) 1997-09-04 1999-03-26 Hokuriku Seiyaku Co Ltd 1-(substitutedaryl)alkyl-1h-imidazopyridin-4-amine derivative
JPH11222432A (en) 1998-02-03 1999-08-17 Terumo Corp Preparation for external use containing amide derivative inducing interferon
US6486168B1 (en) 1999-01-08 2002-11-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Formulations and methods for treatment of mucosal associated conditions with an immune response modifier
EP1140091B1 (en) 1999-01-08 2005-09-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Formulations comprising imiquimod or other immune response modifiers for treating cervical dysplasia
US6558951B1 (en) 1999-02-11 2003-05-06 3M Innovative Properties Company Maturation of dendritic cells with immune response modifying compounds
JP2000247884A (en) 1999-03-01 2000-09-12 Sumitomo Pharmaceut Co Ltd Arachidonic acid-induced skin disease-treating agent
US6451810B1 (en) 1999-06-10 2002-09-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6916925B1 (en) 1999-11-05 2005-07-12 3M Innovative Properties Co. Dye labeled imidazoquinoline compounds
US20020055517A1 (en) 2000-09-15 2002-05-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for delaying recurrence of herpes virus symptoms
JP2002145777A (en) 2000-11-06 2002-05-22 Sumitomo Pharmaceut Co Ltd Therapeutic agent for arachidonic acid-induced dermatosis
US6664260B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterocyclic ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6664264B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Thioether substituted imidazoquinolines
CA2598144A1 (en) 2000-12-08 2006-08-31 3M Innovative Properties Company Compositions and methods for targeted delivery of immune response modifiers
US20020107262A1 (en) 2000-12-08 2002-08-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazopyridines
US6660747B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Amido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6664265B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Amido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6667312B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Thioether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6660735B2 (en) 2000-12-08 2003-12-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinoline ethers
KR100455713B1 (en) 2001-01-29 2004-11-06 호남석유화학 주식회사 Multinuclear metallocene catalysts for olefin polymerization and process for olefin polymerization using the same
US7226928B2 (en) 2001-06-15 2007-06-05 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for the treatment of periodontal disease
JP2005501550A (en) 2001-08-30 2005-01-20 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Maturation of plasmacytoid dendritic cells using immune response modifier molecules
WO2003030902A1 (en) 2001-10-09 2003-04-17 Tularik Inc. Imidazole derivates as anti-inflammatory agents
EP1478371A4 (en) 2001-10-12 2007-11-07 Univ Iowa Res Found Methods and products for enhancing immune responses using imidazoquinoline compounds
AU2004220469B2 (en) 2001-11-29 2010-07-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods of improving skin quality
AU2002363954B2 (en) 2001-11-29 2008-04-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Pharmaceutical formulations comprising an immune response modifier
GB0211649D0 (en) 2002-05-21 2002-07-03 Novartis Ag Organic compounds
JP2005531599A (en) 2002-05-29 2005-10-20 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Method for imidazo [4,5-c] pyridin-4-amine
CN1674894A (en) 2002-06-07 2005-09-28 3M创新有限公司 Ether substituted imidazopyridines
CN1671412B (en) 2002-08-15 2010-05-26 3M创新有限公司 Immunostimulatory compositions and methods of stimulating an immune response
WO2004028539A2 (en) 2002-09-26 2004-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company 1h-imidazo dimers
WO2004053057A2 (en) 2002-12-11 2004-06-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Gene expression systems and recombinant cell lines
WO2004053452A2 (en) 2002-12-11 2004-06-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Assays relating to toll-like receptor activity
MXPA05006740A (en) 2002-12-20 2005-10-05 3M Innovative Properties Co Aryl / hetaryl substituted imidazoquinolines.
EP1578419A4 (en) 2002-12-30 2008-11-12 3M Innovative Properties Co Immunostimulatory combinations
WO2004071459A2 (en) 2003-02-13 2004-08-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods and compositions related to irm compounds and toll-like receptor 8
AU2004218349A1 (en) 2003-03-04 2004-09-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Prophylactic treatment of UV-induced epidermal neoplasia
WO2004080398A2 (en) * 2003-03-07 2004-09-23 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-amino 1h-imidazoquinolines
US20040191833A1 (en) 2003-03-25 2004-09-30 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective activation of cellular activities mediated through a common toll-like receptor
AU2004229478B2 (en) 2003-04-10 2009-12-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Delivery of immune response modifier compounds
US20040265351A1 (en) 2003-04-10 2004-12-30 Miller Richard L. Methods and compositions for enhancing immune response
US20040214851A1 (en) 2003-04-28 2004-10-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Compositions and methods for induction of opioid receptors
US7731967B2 (en) 2003-04-30 2010-06-08 Novartis Vaccines And Diagnostics, Inc. Compositions for inducing immune responses
WO2004110991A2 (en) 2003-06-06 2004-12-23 3M Innovative Properties Company PROCESS FOR IMIDAZO[4,5-c]PYRIDIN-4-AMINES
WO2004110992A2 (en) 2003-06-06 2004-12-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Process for imidazo[4,5-c] pyridin-4-amines
MY157827A (en) 2003-06-27 2016-07-29 3M Innovative Properties Co Sulfonamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US20050106300A1 (en) 2003-06-30 2005-05-19 Purdue Research Foundation Method for producing a material having an increased solubility in alcohol
WO2005018555A2 (en) 2003-08-14 2005-03-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipid-modified immune response modifiers
US8961477B2 (en) 2003-08-25 2015-02-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Delivery of immune response modifier compounds
KR101106812B1 (en) 2003-08-27 2012-01-19 쓰리엠 이노베이티브 프로퍼티즈 컴파니 Aryloxy and Arylalkyleneoxy Substituted Imidazoquinolines
CA2536578A1 (en) 2003-09-02 2005-03-10 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods related to the treatment of mucosal associated conditions
EA200600540A1 (en) 2003-09-05 2006-08-25 Анадис Фармасьютикалз, Инк. INTRODUCTION OF TLR7 LIGANDS AND THEIR TREATMENTS FOR THE TREATMENT OF HEPATITIS C VIRUS INFECTION
WO2005033049A2 (en) 2003-10-01 2005-04-14 Taro Pharmaceuticals U.S.A., Inc. METHOD OF PREPARING 4-AMINO-1H-IMIDAZO(4,5-c)QUINOLINES AND ACID ADDITION SALTS THEREOF
AU2004285575A1 (en) 2003-10-31 2005-05-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Neutrophil activation by immune response modifier compounds
ITMI20032121A1 (en) 2003-11-04 2005-05-05 Dinamite Dipharma Spa In Forma Abbr Eviata Dipharm PROCEDURE FOR THE PREPARATION OF IMIQUIMOD AND ITS INTERMEDIATES
AR046845A1 (en) 2003-11-21 2005-12-28 Novartis Ag DERIVATIVES OF 1H-IMIDAZO [4,5-C] QUINOLINE FOR THE TREATMENT OF PROTEIN-KINASE DEPENDENT DISEASES
AU2004295061B2 (en) 2003-11-21 2008-11-20 Novartis Ag 1H-imidazoquinoline derivatives as protein kinase inhibitors
US8778963B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2014-07-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxylamine and oxime substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
JP2007513165A (en) 2003-12-02 2007-05-24 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Concomitant drugs containing IRM compounds and methods of treatment
TW200533352A (en) 2003-12-04 2005-10-16 3M Innovative Properties Co Sulfone substituted imidazo ring ethers
US20050158325A1 (en) 2003-12-30 2005-07-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunomodulatory combinations
JP2007517055A (en) 2003-12-30 2007-06-28 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Enhanced immune response
US20070167479A1 (en) 2004-03-15 2007-07-19 Busch Terri F Immune response modifier formulations and methods
WO2005094531A2 (en) 2004-03-24 2005-10-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines, imidazoquinolines, and imidazonaphthyridines
AU2005244260B2 (en) 2004-04-09 2010-08-05 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods, compositions, and preparations for delivery of immune response modifiers
US8017779B2 (en) 2004-06-15 2011-09-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Nitrogen containing heterocyclyl substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US7915281B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Isoxazole, dihydroisoxazole, and oxadiazole substituted imidazo ring compounds and method
US20070259907A1 (en) 2004-06-18 2007-11-08 Prince Ryan B Aryl and arylalkylenyl substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
WO2006009826A1 (en) * 2004-06-18 2006-01-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US20070259881A1 (en) 2004-06-18 2007-11-08 Dellaria Joseph F Jr Substituted Imidazo Ring Systems and Methods
EP1789042B1 (en) 2004-09-02 2012-05-02 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-alkoxy 1h-imidazo ring systems and methods
WO2006026760A2 (en) 2004-09-02 2006-03-09 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-amino imidazo-containing compounds and methods
WO2006028451A1 (en) 2004-09-03 2006-03-16 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-amino 1-h-imidazoquinolines
US20080193468A1 (en) 2004-09-08 2008-08-14 Children's Medical Center Corporation Method for Stimulating the Immune Response of Newborns
MX2007003078A (en) 2004-09-14 2007-05-16 Novartis Vaccines & Diagnostic Imidazoquinoline compounds.
JP2008515928A (en) 2004-10-08 2008-05-15 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Adjuvants for DNA vaccines
WO2006063072A2 (en) 2004-12-08 2006-06-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunomodulatory compositions, combinations and methods
JP2008523084A (en) 2004-12-08 2008-07-03 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Immunostimulating combination and method
AU2005322898B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-11-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Chiral fused (1,2)imidazo(4,5-c) ring compounds
EP1835915A4 (en) 2004-12-30 2010-02-24 Coley Pharm Group Inc Immune response modifier formulations and methods
US8436176B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2013-05-07 Medicis Pharmaceutical Corporation Process for preparing 2-methyl-1-(2-methylpropyl)-1H-imidazo[4,5-c][1,5]naphthyridin-4-amine
AR052447A1 (en) 2004-12-30 2007-03-21 3M Innovative Properties Co 1- (2-METIPROPIL) ETANSULFONATE -1H-IMIDAZO [4,5-C] [1,5] NAFTIRIDIN-4- AMINA AND 1- (2- METIPROPIL) -1H-IMIDAZO [4,5-C ] [1,5] NAFTIRIDIN-4-AMINA
WO2006083400A2 (en) 2005-02-02 2006-08-10 Mocon, Inc. Instrument and method for detecting and reporting the size of leaks in hermetically sealed packaging
EP1844201B1 (en) 2005-02-04 2016-08-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
AU2006338521A1 (en) 2005-02-09 2007-10-11 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted thiazolo(4,5-c) ring compounds and methods
JP5122980B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2013-01-16 スリーエム イノベイティブ プロパティズ カンパニー Alkyloxy-substituted thiazoloquinolines and alkyloxy-substituted thiazolonaphthylidenes
JP2008531568A (en) 2005-02-23 2008-08-14 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド Imidazonaphthyridine substituted with hydroxyalkyl
AU2006223148A1 (en) 2005-03-14 2006-09-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of treating actinic keratosis
WO2006121528A2 (en) 2005-04-01 2006-11-16 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Ring closing and related methods and intermediates
JP2008535832A (en) 2005-04-01 2008-09-04 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド Pyrazolopyridine-1,4-diamine and analogs thereof
JP2008538550A (en) 2005-04-01 2008-10-30 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド 1-Substituted pyrazolo (3,4-c) cyclic compounds as modulators of cytokine biosynthesis for treating viral infections and neoplastic diseases
AU2006241166A1 (en) 2005-04-25 2006-11-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunostimulatory compositions
US20100152230A1 (en) 2005-09-02 2010-06-17 Pfizer Inc. Hydroxy substituted 1h-imidazopyridines and methods
BRPI0615788A2 (en) 2005-09-09 2011-05-24 Coley Pharm Group Inc n- {2- [4-amino (ethoxymethyl) -1h-imidazo [4,5-c] quinolin-1-yl] -1,1-dimethylethyl} methanesulfonamide amide and carbamate derivatives, pharmaceutical composition of these and their uses
ZA200803029B (en) 2005-09-09 2009-02-25 Coley Pharm Group Inc Amide and carbamate derivatives of alkyl substituted /V-[4-(4-amino-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-yl)butyl] methane-sulfonamides and methods
US8889154B2 (en) 2005-09-15 2014-11-18 Medicis Pharmaceutical Corporation Packaging for 1-(2-methylpropyl)-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-4-amine-containing formulation
JP4551962B2 (en) 2005-09-23 2010-09-29 コーリー ファーマシューティカル グループ,インコーポレイテッド Process for 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] pyridine and analogs thereof
WO2007056112A2 (en) 2005-11-04 2007-05-18 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1h-imidazoquinolines and methods
EP1968582A4 (en) 2005-12-28 2011-02-16 3M Innovative Properties Co Treatment for cutaneous t cell lymphoma
US20090306388A1 (en) 2006-02-10 2009-12-10 Pfizer Inc. Method for substituted ih-imidazo[4,5-c] pyridines
WO2007106852A2 (en) 2006-03-15 2007-09-20 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Substituted fused[1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8329721B2 (en) 2006-03-15 2012-12-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazonaphthyridines and methods
US8178539B2 (en) 2006-09-06 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted 3,4,6,7-tetrahydro-5H-1,2a,4a,8-tetraazacyclopenta[cd]phenalenes and methods
US20080149123A1 (en) 2006-12-22 2008-06-26 Mckay William D Particulate material dispensing hairbrush with combination bristles

Patent Citations (100)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7301A (en) * 1850-04-23 Machine for drilling stone
US76828A (en) * 1868-04-14 Improvement in gas-heaters
US3314941A (en) * 1964-06-23 1967-04-18 American Cyanamid Co Novel substituted pyridodiazepins
US4902211A (en) * 1983-01-24 1990-02-20 Svanholm Engineering Ab Process and plant for manufacture of aerated concrete
US4988815A (en) * 1989-10-26 1991-01-29 Riker Laboratories, Inc. 3-Amino or 3-nitro quinoline compounds which are intermediates in preparing 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolines
US5389640A (en) * 1991-03-01 1995-02-14 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 1-substituted, 2-substituted 1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-4-amines
US5714608A (en) * 1991-09-04 1998-02-03 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company 1-substituted 1H-imidazo- 4,5-c!quinolin-4-amines
US5395937A (en) * 1993-01-29 1995-03-07 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for preparing quinoline amines
US5494916A (en) * 1993-07-15 1996-02-27 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-C]pyridin-4-amines
US5886006A (en) * 1993-07-15 1999-03-23 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Fused cycloalkylimidazopyridines
US5482936A (en) * 1995-01-12 1996-01-09 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Imidazo[4,5-C]quinoline amines
US5741908A (en) * 1996-06-21 1998-04-21 Minnesota Mining And Manufacturing Company Process for reparing imidazoquinolinamines
US6039969A (en) * 1996-10-25 2000-03-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier compounds for treatment of TH2 mediated and related diseases
US6696076B2 (en) * 1996-10-25 2004-02-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier compounds for treatment of TH2 mediated and related diseases
US6200592B1 (en) * 1996-10-25 2001-03-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Immine response modifier compounds for treatment of TH2 mediated and related diseases
US6365166B2 (en) * 1996-12-03 2002-04-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Gel formulations for topical drug delivery
US6514985B1 (en) * 1997-12-11 2003-02-04 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazonaphthyridines
US6194425B1 (en) * 1997-12-11 2001-02-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazonaphthyridines
US6703402B2 (en) * 1998-07-28 2004-03-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxazolo, thiazolo and selenazolo [4,5-c]-quinolin-4-amines and analogs thereof
US6518265B1 (en) * 1998-08-12 2003-02-11 Hokuriku Seiyaku Co., Ltd. 1H-imidazopyridine derivatives
US6706728B2 (en) * 1999-01-08 2004-03-16 3M Innovative Properties Company Systems and methods for treating a mucosal surface
US7030131B2 (en) * 1999-06-10 2006-04-18 Crooks Stephen L Sulfonamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US7157453B2 (en) * 1999-06-10 2007-01-02 3M Innovation Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinolines
US20090023722A1 (en) * 1999-06-10 2009-01-22 Coleman Patrick L Amide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6541485B1 (en) * 1999-06-10 2003-04-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazoquinolines
US6376669B1 (en) * 1999-11-05 2002-04-23 3M Innovative Properties Company Dye labeled imidazoquinoline compounds
US6894060B2 (en) * 2000-03-30 2005-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Method for the treatment of dermal lesions caused by envenomation
US6720422B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines
US6677348B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6683088B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6716988B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-04-06 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazopyridines
US6720334B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea substituted imidazopyridines
US6720333B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-04-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines
US6525064B1 (en) * 2000-12-08 2003-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido substituted imidazopyridines
US6677347B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6989389B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2006-01-24 3M Innovative Properties Co. Aryl ether substituted imidazoquinolines
US6696465B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2004-02-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido substituted imidazopyridines
US6878719B2 (en) * 2000-12-08 2005-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamido substituted imidazopyridines
US20040014779A1 (en) * 2001-11-16 2004-01-22 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods and compositions related to IRM compounds and toll-like recptor pathways
US7199131B2 (en) * 2001-12-21 2007-04-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamide and sulfamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US6677349B1 (en) * 2001-12-21 2004-01-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Sulfonamide and sulfamide substituted imidazoquinolines
US7030129B2 (en) * 2002-02-22 2006-04-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of reducing and treating UVB-induced immunosuppression
US20060088542A1 (en) * 2002-03-19 2006-04-27 Powdermed Limited Imidazoquinoline adjuvants for vaccines
US6852861B2 (en) * 2002-07-23 2005-02-08 Biogal Gyogyszergyar Rt. Preparation of 1H-imidazo [4,5-C] quinolin-4-amines via 1H-imidazo [4,5-C] quinolin-4-phthalimide intermediates
US6841678B2 (en) * 2002-07-26 2005-01-11 Biogal Gyogyszergyar Rt. Preparation of 1H-imidazo [4,5-C] quinolin-4-amines via novel 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] quinolin-4-cyano and 1H-imidazo [4,5-c] quinolin-4-carboxamide intermediates
US7485432B2 (en) * 2003-02-27 2009-02-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective modulation of TLR-mediated biological activity
US7163947B2 (en) * 2003-03-07 2007-01-16 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-Amino 1H-imidazoquinolines
US7179253B2 (en) * 2003-03-13 2007-02-20 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of tattoo removal
US7699057B2 (en) * 2003-03-13 2010-04-20 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for treating skin lesions
US7696159B2 (en) * 2003-03-25 2010-04-13 Graceway Pharmaceuticals, Llc Treatment for basal cell carcinoma
US20080063714A1 (en) * 2003-07-31 2008-03-13 Hassan Sahouani Compositions for Encapsulation and Controlled Release
US20080039533A1 (en) * 2003-07-31 2008-02-14 3M Innovative Properties Company Bioactive Compositions Comprising Triazines
US20050070460A1 (en) * 2003-08-05 2005-03-31 3M Innovative Properties Company Infection prophylaxis using immune response modifier compounds
US20070066639A1 (en) * 2003-08-12 2007-03-22 Kshirsagar Tushar A Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US7648997B2 (en) * 2003-08-12 2010-01-19 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxylamine substituted imidazoquinolines
US20050048072A1 (en) * 2003-08-25 2005-03-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Immunostimulatory combinations and treatments
US20090017076A1 (en) * 2003-09-05 2009-01-15 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Treatment for cd5+ b cell lymphoma
US20050059072A1 (en) * 2003-09-17 2005-03-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Selective modulation of TLR gene expression
US20070060754A1 (en) * 2003-10-03 2007-03-15 Lindstrom Kyle J Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US7879849B2 (en) * 2003-10-03 2011-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US20090075980A1 (en) * 2003-10-03 2009-03-19 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolopyridines and Analogs Thereof
US20090105295A1 (en) * 2003-11-14 2009-04-23 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxylamine substituted imidazoquinolines
US7897767B2 (en) * 2003-11-14 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US20070072893A1 (en) * 2003-11-25 2007-03-29 Krepski Larry R Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US20090030030A1 (en) * 2003-12-29 2009-01-29 Bonk Jason D Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US7888349B2 (en) * 2003-12-29 2011-02-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Piperazine, [1,4]Diazepane, [1,4]Diazocane, and [1,5]Diazocane fused imidazo ring compounds
US20090062272A1 (en) * 2003-12-30 2009-03-05 Bonk Jason D Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
US20060051374A1 (en) * 2004-04-28 2006-03-09 3M Innovative Properties Company Compositions and methods for mucosal vaccination
US20080015184A1 (en) * 2004-06-14 2008-01-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Urea Substituted Imidazopyridines, Imidazoquinolines, and Imidazonaphthyridines
US7897609B2 (en) * 2004-06-18 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
US7884207B2 (en) * 2004-06-18 2011-02-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US20060045885A1 (en) * 2004-08-27 2006-03-02 Kedl Ross M Method of eliciting an immune response against HIV
US20060045886A1 (en) * 2004-08-27 2006-03-02 Kedl Ross M HIV immunostimulatory compositions
US20090023720A1 (en) * 2004-09-02 2009-01-22 Kshirsagar Tushar A 2-Amino 1H-Imidazo Ring Systems and Methods
US7902212B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Reduction of imiquimod impurities at six months using refined oleic acid
US7902245B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for reducing imiquimod impurities for two months, four months, and six months
US7902209B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Proerties Company Method of preparing a pharmaceutical cream and minimizing imiquimod impurity formation
US7655672B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2010-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier formulations containing oleic acid and methods
US7902214B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of treating a mucosal and/or dermal associated condition
US7902215B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Pharmaceutical creams with reduced imiquimod impurities
US7902246B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for controlling formation of imiquimod impurities for two months, four months, and six months
US7902213B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Pharmaceutical cream with reduced imiquimod impurities at four months using refined oleic acid
US7902210B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Reduction of IMIQUIMOD impurities at two months using refined oleic acid
US7902216B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Pharmaceutical creams with refined oleic acid
US7902243B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods for improving imiquimod availability at two months, four months and six months between refined and compendial
US7902244B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of preparing a pharmaceutical cream and minimizing imiquimod impurity formation (at least four months storage)
US7902242B2 (en) * 2004-12-17 2011-03-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of stabilizing imiquimod
US20080085895A1 (en) * 2004-12-30 2008-04-10 Griesgraber George W Substituted Chiral Fused [1,2]Imidazo[4,5-C] Ring Compounds
US20100056557A1 (en) * 2004-12-30 2010-03-04 Bernd Benninghoff Treatment for cutaneous metastases
US20090062328A1 (en) * 2005-02-11 2009-03-05 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Oxime and Hydroxylamine Substituted Imidazo[4,5-c] Ring Compounds and Methods
US20090005371A1 (en) * 2005-02-11 2009-01-01 Rice Michael J Substituted Fused [1,2]Imidazo[4,5-C] Ring Compounds and Methods
US20090099161A1 (en) * 2005-02-11 2009-04-16 Coley Pharmaceutial Group, Inc. Substituted Imidazoquinolines and Imidazonaphthyridines
US20090030031A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2009-01-29 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Method of Preferentially Inducing the Biosynthesis of Interferon
US20090029988A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2009-01-29 Coley Pharmaceutical Grop, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl Substituted Imidazoquinolines
US20090069314A1 (en) * 2005-02-23 2009-03-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Hydroxyalkyl Substituted Imidazoquinoline Compounds and Methods
US20090069299A1 (en) * 2005-04-01 2009-03-12 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Pyrazolo[3,4-c]Quinolines, Pyrazolo[3,4-c]Naphthyridines, Analogs Thereof, and Methods
US20090035323A1 (en) * 2006-02-22 2009-02-05 Doris Stoermer Immune response modifier conjugates
US20100028381A1 (en) * 2006-06-19 2010-02-04 3M Innovative Properties Company Formulation for delivery of immune response modifiers
US20080070907A1 (en) * 2006-07-12 2008-03-20 Coley Pharmaceutical Group, Inc. Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-C] ring compounds and methods
US20100096287A1 (en) * 2006-07-31 2010-04-22 Stoesz James D Immune Response Modifier Compositions and Methods

Cited By (75)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9801947B2 (en) 2003-04-10 2017-10-31 3M Innovative Properties Company Methods and compositions for enhancing immune response
US8673932B2 (en) 2003-08-12 2014-03-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazo-containing compounds
US7897597B2 (en) 2003-08-27 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US8263594B2 (en) 2003-08-27 2012-09-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US7923429B2 (en) 2003-09-05 2011-04-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Treatment for CD5+ B cell lymphoma
US8871782B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2014-10-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US7879849B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2011-02-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US9856254B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2018-01-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US9145410B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2015-09-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridines and analogs thereof
US9365567B2 (en) 2003-10-03 2016-06-14 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkoxy substituted imidazoquinolines
US8598192B2 (en) 2003-11-14 2013-12-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxylamine substituted imidazoquinolines
US7897767B2 (en) 2003-11-14 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime substituted imidazoquinolines
US9328110B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2016-05-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US9765071B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2017-09-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US8691837B2 (en) 2003-11-25 2014-04-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazo ring systems and methods
US8802853B2 (en) 2003-12-29 2014-08-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Arylalkenyl and arylalkynyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US8735421B2 (en) 2003-12-30 2014-05-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Imidazoquinolinyl sulfonamides
US8697873B2 (en) 2004-03-24 2014-04-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazopyridines, imidazoquinolines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US8017779B2 (en) 2004-06-15 2011-09-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Nitrogen containing heterocyclyl substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US8541438B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2013-09-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US9550773B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2017-01-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US8026366B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-09-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryloxy and arylalkyleneoxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US9938275B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2018-04-10 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US7915281B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Isoxazole, dihydroisoxazole, and oxadiazole substituted imidazo ring compounds and method
US7897609B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2011-03-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Aryl substituted imidazonaphthyridines
US9006264B2 (en) 2004-06-18 2015-04-14 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines, imidazopyridines, and imidazonaphthyridines
US8546383B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2013-10-01 3M Innovative Properties Company Chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
US8350034B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2013-01-08 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds
US8207162B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2012-06-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
US8034938B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-10-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds
US7943609B2 (en) 2004-12-30 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Proprerties Company Chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds
US9248127B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2016-02-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
US10071156B2 (en) 2005-02-04 2018-09-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Aqueous gel formulations containing immune response modifiers
US8378102B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2013-02-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted thiazolo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US9546184B2 (en) 2005-02-09 2017-01-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US8658666B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2014-02-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US7968563B2 (en) 2005-02-11 2011-06-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Oxime and hydroxylamine substituted imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8178677B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinolines
US8846710B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2014-09-30 3M Innovative Properties Company Method of preferentially inducing the biosynthesis of interferon
US8158794B2 (en) 2005-02-23 2012-04-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinoline compounds and methods
US7943636B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company 1-substituted pyrazolo (3,4-C) ring compounds as modulators of cytokine biosynthesis for the treatment of viral infections and neoplastic diseases
US7943610B2 (en) 2005-04-01 2011-05-17 3M Innovative Properties Company Pyrazolopyridine-1,4-diamines and analogs thereof
US8188111B2 (en) 2005-09-09 2012-05-29 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide and carbamate derivatives of alkyl substituted N-[4-(4-amino-1H-imidazo[4,5-c]quinolin-1-yl)butyI]methanesulfonamides and methods
US8476292B2 (en) 2005-09-09 2013-07-02 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide and carbamate derivatives of N-{2-[4-amino-2-(ethoxymethyl)-1H-imidazo[4,5-c] quinolin-1-Yl]-1,1-dimethylethyl}methanesulfonamide and methods
US8377957B2 (en) 2005-11-04 2013-02-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazoquinolines and methods
US8088790B2 (en) 2005-11-04 2012-01-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazoquinolines and methods
US10472420B2 (en) 2006-02-22 2019-11-12 3M Innovative Properties Company Immune response modifier conjugates
US8329721B2 (en) 2006-03-15 2012-12-11 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazonaphthyridines and methods
US7906506B2 (en) 2006-07-12 2011-03-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted chiral fused [1,2] imidazo [4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8178539B2 (en) 2006-09-06 2012-05-15 3M Innovative Properties Company Substituted 3,4,6,7-tetrahydro-5H-1,2a,4a,8-tetraazacyclopenta[cd]phenalenes and methods
CN104761471A (en) * 2008-11-06 2015-07-08 日产化学工业株式会社 Liquid crystal aligning agent
US10722573B2 (en) 2009-03-25 2020-07-28 The Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions for stimulation of mammalian innate immune resistance to pathogens
US9504742B2 (en) 2009-03-25 2016-11-29 The Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions for stimulation of mammalian innate immune resistance to pathogens
US9186400B2 (en) 2009-03-25 2015-11-17 The Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions for stimulation of mammalian innate immune resistance to pathogens
US8883174B2 (en) 2009-03-25 2014-11-11 The Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions for stimulation of mammalian innate immune resistance to pathogens
US9795669B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2017-10-24 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US11524071B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2022-12-13 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US9242980B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2016-01-26 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US10821176B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2020-11-03 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US10383938B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2019-08-20 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US10052380B2 (en) 2010-08-17 2018-08-21 3M Innovative Properties Company Lipidated immune response modifier compound compositions, formulations, and methods
US10723731B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2020-07-28 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterobifunctional linkers with polyethylene glycol segments and immune response modifier conjugates made therefrom
US9585968B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2017-03-07 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydrazino 1H-imidazoquinolin-4-amines and conjugates made therefrom
US9107958B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2015-08-18 3M Innovative Properties Company Hydrazino 1H-imidazoquinolin-4-amines and conjugates made therefrom
US10406142B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2019-09-10 3M Lnnovative Properties Company Hydrazino 1H-imidazoquinolin-4-amines and conjugates made therefrom
US9902724B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2018-02-27 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterobifunctional linkers with polyethylene glycol segments and immune response modifier conjugates made therefrom
US9475804B2 (en) 2011-06-03 2016-10-25 3M Innovative Properties Company Heterobifunctional linkers with polyethylene glycol segments and immune response modifier conjugates made therefrom
US20150072974A1 (en) * 2012-05-09 2015-03-12 Sunovion Pharmaceuticals Inc. Heteroaryl compounds and methods of use thereof
US9951088B2 (en) * 2012-05-09 2018-04-24 Sunovion Pharmaceuticals Inc. D2 receptor modulators and methods of use thereof in the treatment of diseases and disorders
US10286065B2 (en) 2014-09-19 2019-05-14 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Compositions and methods for treating viral infections through stimulated innate immunity in combination with antiviral compounds
US10513515B2 (en) 2017-08-25 2019-12-24 Biotheryx, Inc. Ether compounds and uses thereof
US10927104B2 (en) 2017-08-25 2021-02-23 Biotheryx, Inc. Ether compounds and uses thereof
US11306083B2 (en) 2017-12-20 2022-04-19 3M Innovative Properties Company Amide substituted imidazo[4,5-C]quinoline compounds with a branched chain linking group for use as an immune response modifier
US11236103B2 (en) 2018-07-27 2022-02-01 Biotheryx, Inc. Bifunctional compounds
US11897930B2 (en) 2020-04-28 2024-02-13 Anwita Biosciences, Inc. Interleukin-2 polypeptides and fusion proteins thereof, and their pharmaceutical compositions and therapeutic applications

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20170088559A1 (en) 2017-03-30
JP5122980B2 (en) 2013-01-16
EP1846419B1 (en) 2014-04-16
JP2008530099A (en) 2008-08-07
CA2597324C (en) 2015-06-30
US20150266901A1 (en) 2015-09-24
WO2006086449A3 (en) 2007-07-05
ES2475728T3 (en) 2014-07-11
AU2006212765A1 (en) 2006-08-17
AU2006212765B2 (en) 2012-02-02
EP1846419A4 (en) 2010-07-07
US9546184B2 (en) 2017-01-17
US20180057509A1 (en) 2018-03-01
CA2597324A1 (en) 2006-08-17
WO2006086449A2 (en) 2006-08-17
EP1846419A2 (en) 2007-10-24

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US9546184B2 (en) Alkyloxy substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US8088790B2 (en) Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazoquinolines and methods
US8158794B2 (en) Hydroxyalkyl substituted imidazoquinoline compounds and methods
US8093390B2 (en) Substituted fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds and methods
US8143270B2 (en) 2-amino 1H-in-imidazo ring systems and methods
US8088788B2 (en) Substituted fused[1,2] imidazo[4,5-c] ring compounds and methods
US8350034B2 (en) Substituted chiral fused [1,2]imidazo[4,5-C] ring compounds
US20080015184A1 (en) Urea Substituted Imidazopyridines, Imidazoquinolines, and Imidazonaphthyridines
US8658666B2 (en) Substituted imidazoquinolines and imidazonaphthyridines
US8178539B2 (en) Substituted 3,4,6,7-tetrahydro-5H-1,2a,4a,8-tetraazacyclopenta[cd]phenalenes and methods
US7939526B2 (en) Sulfone substituted imidazo ring ethers
US8329721B2 (en) Hydroxy and alkoxy substituted 1H-imidazonaphthyridines and methods
US20070259881A1 (en) Substituted Imidazo Ring Systems and Methods
US20070259907A1 (en) Aryl and arylalkylenyl substituted thiazoloquinolines and thiazolonaphthyridines
US20070213356A1 (en) Nitrogen-Containing Heterocyclyl Substituted Imidazoquinolines and Imidazonaphthyridines

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY, MIN

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:PRINCE, RYAN B.;MERRILL, BYRON A.;HEPPNER, PHILIP D.;AND OTHERS;REEL/FRAME:020932/0583;SIGNING DATES FROM 20051118 TO 20051121

Owner name: 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY, MIN

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:PRINCE, RYAN B.;MERRILL, BYRON A.;HEPPNER, PHILIP D.;AND OTHERS;REEL/FRAME:020933/0005

Effective date: 20050224

Owner name: 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY & 3M COMPANY, MIN

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:RICE, MICHAEL J.;REEL/FRAME:020932/0451

Effective date: 20080220

Owner name: COLEY PHARMACEUTICAL GROUP, INC., MASSACHUSETTS

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:3M COMPANY & 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY;REEL/FRAME:020935/0870

Effective date: 20070723

AS Assignment

Owner name: 3M INNOVATIVE PROPERTIES COMPANY, MINNESOTA

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:COLEY PHARMACEUTICAL GROUP, INC.;REEL/FRAME:025839/0772

Effective date: 20110131

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION